blob: 73d694c601593d212d5d66aba78f616f54a49fc5 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau9dc6b972019-06-16 21:49:47 +02005 version 2.1
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreauc70df532019-10-25 15:48:53 +02007 2019/10/25
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200677. Using ACLs and fetching samples
687.1. ACL basics
697.1.1. Matching booleans
707.1.2. Matching integers
717.1.3. Matching strings
727.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
737.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
747.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
757.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
767.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200777.3.1. Converters
787.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
797.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
807.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
817.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
827.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200837.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200856. Cache
866.1. Limitation
876.2. Setup
886.2.1. Cache section
896.2.2. Proxy section
90
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200918. Logging
928.1. Log levels
938.2. Log formats
948.2.1. Default log format
958.2.2. TCP log format
968.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100978.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100988.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200998.3. Advanced logging options
1008.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1018.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1028.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1038.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1048.4. Timing events
1058.5. Session state at disconnection
1068.6. Non-printable characters
1078.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1088.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1098.9. Examples of logs
110
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001119. Supported filters
1129.1. Trace
1139.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001149.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001159.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001169.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200117
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011810. FastCGI applications
11910.1. Setup
12010.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12110.1.2. Proxy section
12210.1.3. Example
12310.2. Default parameters
12410.3. Limitations
125
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126
1271. Quick reminder about HTTP
128----------------------------
129
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100130When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
132on almost anything found in the contents.
133
134However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
135formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
136correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
137
138
1391.1. The HTTP transaction model
140-------------------------------
141
142The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100143to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100144from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
145connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146will involve a new connection :
147
148 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
149
150In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
151establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
152by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
153length.
154
155Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
156to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
157however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
158response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
159header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
160
161 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
162
163Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
164power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
165but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200166a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100168Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
170second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
171page :
172
173 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
174
175This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
176latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
177correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
178the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100179server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
182time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
183are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
184parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
185carry the stream identifier.
186
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
188connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
189leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100190start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
191processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
192waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200193
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200194HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100195 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
196 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100197 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200199 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100201For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
202the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100203server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
204is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
205servers.
206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207
2081.2. HTTP request
209-----------------
210
211First, let's consider this HTTP request :
212
213 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100214 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
216 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
217 3 User-agent: my small browser
218 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
219 5 Accept: image/png
220
221
2221.2.1. The Request line
223-----------------------
224
225Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
226
227 - a METHOD : GET
228 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
229 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
230
231All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
232which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
233followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
234is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
235desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
236the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
237
238The URI itself can have several forms :
239
240 - A "relative URI" :
241
242 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
243
244 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
245 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
246
247 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
248
249 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
250
251 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
252 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
253 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
254 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
255 must accept this form too.
256
257 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
258 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
259 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200261 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
262 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
263 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
264 other protocols too.
265
266In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
267mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
268on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
269It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
270specific to the language, framework or application in use.
271
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100272HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100273assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
275received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
276processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
277as well as in server logs.
278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200279
2801.2.2. The request headers
281--------------------------
282
283The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
284beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
285an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
286Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
287values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
288encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
289the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
290define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
291
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100292Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100294"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
295as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296
297The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
298that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
299is one valid form of empty line.
300
301Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
302headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
303about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
304application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
305
306Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000307 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
309 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
310 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
311
312
3131.3. HTTP response
314------------------
315
316An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
317messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
318
319 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100320 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200321 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
322 2 Content-length: 350
323 3 Content-Type: text/html
324
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200325As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
326codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
327response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100328continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
329the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
330following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
331sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
332(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
333correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
334such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
335state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
336over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
337if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
338information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200340
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003411.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342------------------------
343
344Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
345
346 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
347 - a status code : 200
348 - a reason : OK
349
350The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100351 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
352 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
353 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
354 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
355 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000357Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100358"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
360messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
361or "Authentication Required".
362
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100363HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364
365 Code When / reason
366 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
367 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
368 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
369 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100370 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200372 400 for an invalid or too large request
373 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
374 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200375 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
377 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
378 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
379 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
382 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
383 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
384
385The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3864.2).
387
388
3891.3.2. The response headers
390---------------------------
391
392Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
393the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
394details.
395
396
3972. Configuring HAProxy
398----------------------
399
4002.1. Configuration file format
401------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200402
403HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
404
405 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
406 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
407 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
408 "frontend" and "backend".
409
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100410The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
411referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200414
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004152.2. Quoting and escaping
416-------------------------
417
418HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
419many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
420with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
421single quotes.
422
423If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
424them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
425escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
426
427Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
428
429 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
430 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
431 \\ to use a backslash
432 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
433 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
434
435Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
436the interpretation of:
437
438 space as a parameter separator
439 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
440 # hash as a comment start
441
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200442Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
443-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
444backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
445
446Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200447quoting.
448
449Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
450nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
451
452Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
453equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
454
455 Example:
456 # those are equivalents:
457 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
458 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
459 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
460 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
461 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
462
463 # those are equivalents:
464 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
465 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
466 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
467 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
468
469
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004702.3. Environment variables
471--------------------------
472
473HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
474interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
475configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
476optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
477shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
478underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
479
480 Example:
481
482 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
483
484 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
485
486 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
487
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200488Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
489file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200490
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200491* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
492 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
493
494* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
495 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
496 directory.
497
498* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
499
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500500* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200501 processes, separated by semicolons.
502
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500503* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200504 CLI, separated by semicolons.
505
506See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200507
5082.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200509----------------
510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100511Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100512values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
513otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
514numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
515for every keyword. Supported units are :
516
517 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
518 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
519 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
520 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
521 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
522 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
523
524
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005252.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200526-------------
527
528 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
529 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
530 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
531 global
532 daemon
533 maxconn 256
534
535 defaults
536 mode http
537 timeout connect 5000ms
538 timeout client 50000ms
539 timeout server 50000ms
540
541 frontend http-in
542 bind *:80
543 default_backend servers
544
545 backend servers
546 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
547
548
549 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
550 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
551 global
552 daemon
553 maxconn 256
554
555 defaults
556 mode http
557 timeout connect 5000ms
558 timeout client 50000ms
559 timeout server 50000ms
560
561 listen http-in
562 bind *:80
563 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
564
565
566Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
567
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100568 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200569
570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005713. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200572--------------------
573
574Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
575are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
576of them have command-line equivalents.
577
578The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
579
580 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200581 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200582 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200583 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200584 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200585 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200586 - description
587 - deviceatlas-json-file
588 - deviceatlas-log-level
589 - deviceatlas-separator
590 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900591 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200592 - gid
593 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100594 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200595 - h1-case-adjust
596 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200598 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100599 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200600 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200601 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200602 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200603 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200604 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100606 - presetenv
607 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608 - uid
609 - ulimit-n
610 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200611 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100612 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200613 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200614 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200615 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200616 - ssl-default-bind-options
617 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200618 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200619 - ssl-default-server-options
620 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100621 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100622 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100623 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100624 - 51degrees-data-file
625 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200626 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200627 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200628 - wurfl-data-file
629 - wurfl-information-list
630 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200631 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100632
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200633 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200634 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200635 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200636 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100637 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100638 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100639 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200640 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200641 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200642 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200643 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200644 - noepoll
645 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000646 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200647 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100648 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300649 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000650 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100651 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200652 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200653 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200654 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000655 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000656 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200657 - tune.buffers.limit
658 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200659 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200660 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100661 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200662 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200663 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200664 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100665 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200666 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200667 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100668 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100669 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100670 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100671 - tune.lua.session-timeout
672 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200673 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100674 - tune.maxaccept
675 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200676 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200677 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200678 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100679 - tune.rcvbuf.client
680 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100681 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200682 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100683 - tune.sndbuf.client
684 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100685 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100686 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200687 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100688 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200689 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200690 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100691 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200692 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100693 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200694 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
695 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
696 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100697 - tune.zlib.memlevel
698 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100699
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200700 * Debugging
701 - debug
702 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200703
704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007053.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200706------------------------------------
707
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200708ca-base <dir>
709 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200710 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
711 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200712
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200713chroot <jail dir>
714 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
715 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
716 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
717 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
718 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100719 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100720
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100721cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
722 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
723 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
724 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
725 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
726 set. These sets have the format
727
728 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
729
730 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100731 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100732 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
733 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100734 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
735 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100736 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100737 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100738 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100739 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
741 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
742 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
743 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100744
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100745 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
746 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
747 on the machine's word size.
748
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100749 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100750 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
751 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
752 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
753 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
754 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
755 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100756
757 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100758 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
759
760 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
761 # first 4 CPUs
762
763 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
764 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
765 # word size.
766
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100767 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100768 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100769 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
770 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
771 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
772
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100773 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
774 # and so on.
775 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
776 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
777 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
778
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100779 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100780 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
781 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
782 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
783
784 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
785 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
786 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
787
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100788 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
789 # and a thread range.
790 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
791 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
792 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
793
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200794crt-base <dir>
795 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
796 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
797 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
798
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200799daemon
800 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
801 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100802 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
803 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200804
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200805deviceatlas-json-file <path>
806 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100807 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200808
809deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100810 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200811 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
812
813deviceatlas-separator <char>
814 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
815 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
816
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100817deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200818 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
819 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
820 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100821
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900822external-check
823 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
824 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
825 See "option external-check".
826
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200827gid <number>
828 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
829 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
830 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100831 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
832 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200833 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100834
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100835hard-stop-after <time>
836 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
837
838 Arguments :
839 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
840 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
841 SIGUSR1 signal.
842
843 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
844 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
845 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
846
847 Example:
848 global
849 hard-stop-after 30s
850
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200851h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
852 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
853 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
854 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
855 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
856 ajusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
857 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
858 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
859 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
860 specified in a proxy.
861
862 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
863 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
864 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
865 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
866 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
867 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
868 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
869
870 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
871 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
872 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
873 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
874 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
875
876 Example:
877 global
878 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
879
880 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
881 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
882
883h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
884 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
885 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
886 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
887 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
888 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
889 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
890 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
891 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
892
893 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
894 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
895 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
896
897 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
898 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
899
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200900group <group name>
901 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
902 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100903
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200904log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
905 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100906 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100907 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100908 configured with "log global".
909
910 <address> can be one of:
911
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100912 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100913 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
914 port).
915
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100916 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
917 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
918 port).
919
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100920 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100921 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
922 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100923 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100924
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100925 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
926 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
927 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
928 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
929 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
930 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
931 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
932 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
933 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
934 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
935 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
936 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
937 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
938 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100939 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
940 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100941
942 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
943 "fd@2", see above.
944
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +0200945 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
946 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
947 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
948 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
949 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
950
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200951 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
952 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100953
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200954 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
955 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
956 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
957 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
958 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
959 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
960 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
961 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
962 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
963 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100964 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
965 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200966
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200967 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
968 one of the following :
969
970 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
971 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
972
973 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
974 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
975
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100976 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
977 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
978 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
979 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
980 logger consumes.
981
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100982 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
983 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
984 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
985 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
986
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200987 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
988 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
989 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
990 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
991 set with <sample_size> parameter.
992
993 <sample_size>
994 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
995 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
996 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
997 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
998 (see also <ranges> parameter).
999
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001000 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001001
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001002 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1003 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1004 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1005
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001006 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1007 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1008 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1009 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001010
1011 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001012 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1013 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1014 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1015 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1016 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1017 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001018
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001019 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001020
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001021log-send-hostname [<string>]
1022 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1023 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1024 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1025 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1026 the logs.
1027
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001028log-tag <string>
1029 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1030 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1031 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001032 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001033
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001034lua-load <file>
1035 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1036 used multiple times.
1037
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001038master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001039 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1040 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1041 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001042 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001043 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1044 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001045 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1046 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1047 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1048 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1049 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001050
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001051 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001052
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001053mworker-max-reloads <number>
1054 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001055 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001056 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1057 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1058 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1059
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001060nbproc <number>
1061 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1062 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1063 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001064 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1065 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001066 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1067 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001069nbthread <number>
1070 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001071 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1072 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1073 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1074 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1075 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001076 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1077 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1078 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1079 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1080 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1081 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1082 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001083
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001084pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001085 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001086 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1087 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1088
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001089presetenv <name> <value>
1090 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1091 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1092 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1093 and "unsetenv".
1094
1095resetenv [<name> ...]
1096 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1097 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1098 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1099 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1100 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1101 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1102 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1103 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1104
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001105stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001106 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1107 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1108 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1109 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1110 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1111 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001112 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001113 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1114 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1115 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1116 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001117
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001118server-state-base <directory>
1119 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001120 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1121 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001122
1123server-state-file <file>
1124 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1125 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1126 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1127 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1128 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1129 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1130 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1131 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001132 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1133 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001134
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001135setenv <name> <value>
1136 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1137 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1138 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1139 and "unsetenv".
1140
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001141set-dumpable
1142 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1143 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1144 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1145 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1146 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1147 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1148 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1149 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1150 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1151 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1152 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1153 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1154 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1155 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1156 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1157 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1158 expected when dying.
1159
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001160ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1161 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1162 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001163 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001164 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001165 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1166 information and recommendations see e.g.
1167 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1168 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1169 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1170 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001171
1172ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1173 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1174 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1175 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1176 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1177 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001178 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1179 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1180 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001181 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001182
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001183ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1184 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1185 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1186 keyword to see available options.
1187
1188 Example:
1189 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001190 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001191
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001192ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1193 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1194 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001195 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001196 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001197 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1198 information and recommendations see e.g.
1199 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1200 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1201 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1202 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1203 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001204
1205ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1206 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1207 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1208 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1209 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1210 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001211 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1212 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1213 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1214 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001215
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001216ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1217 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1218 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1219 keyword to see available options.
1220
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001221ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1222 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1223 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1224 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001225 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001226 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001227 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1228 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1229 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1230 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001231 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1232 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1233 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1234
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001235ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1236 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1237 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1238 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1239
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001240stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1241 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1242 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1243 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001244 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001245 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001246
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001247 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1248 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1249 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001250
1251stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1252 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1253 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001254 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001255
1256stats maxconn <connections>
1257 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1258 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1259
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001260uid <number>
1261 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1262 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1263 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1264 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1265
1266ulimit-n <number>
1267 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1268 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1269 option.
1270
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001271unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1272 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1273
1274 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1275 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1276 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1277 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1278 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1279 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1280 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1281 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1282 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1283 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1284
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001285unsetenv [<name> ...]
1286 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1287 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1288 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1289 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1290 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1291 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1292 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1293
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001294user <user name>
1295 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1296 See also "uid" and "group".
1297
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001298node <name>
1299 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1300
1301 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1302 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1303 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1304 traffic.
1305
1306description <text>
1307 Add a text that describes the instance.
1308
1309 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1310 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1311 "<" and ">" characters.
1312
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100131351degrees-data-file <file path>
1314 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001315 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001316
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001317 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001318 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1319
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000132051degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001321 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1322 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1323 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1324
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001325 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001326 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1327
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200132851degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001329 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1330 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1331
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001332 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1333 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1334
133551degrees-cache-size <number>
1336 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1337 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1338 By default, this cache is disabled.
1339
1340 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001341 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1342
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001343wurfl-data-file <file path>
1344 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1345 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1346
1347 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1348 with USE_WURFL=1.
1349
1350wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1351 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1352 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1353 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1354
1355 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1356
1357 Valid WURFL properties are:
1358 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1359
1360 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1361 device.
1362
1363 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1364 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1365
1366 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1367 particular web request.
1368
1369 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1370 used Libwurfl API version.
1371
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001372 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1373 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1374
1375 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1376 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1377
1378 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1379
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001380 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1381 with USE_WURFL=1.
1382
1383wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1384 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1385 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1386
1387 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1388 with USE_WURFL=1.
1389
1390wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1391 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1392 thus before the chroot.
1393
1394 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1395 with USE_WURFL=1.
1396
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001397wurfl-cache-size <size>
1398 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1399 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001400 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001401 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001402
1403 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1404 with USE_WURFL=1.
1405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014063.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001407-----------------------
1408
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001409busy-polling
1410 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1411 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1412 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1413 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1414 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1415 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1416 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1417 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1418 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1419 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1420 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1421 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1422 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1423 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1424 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1425 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1426 "poll" pollers.
1427
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001428max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1429 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1430 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1431 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1432 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1433 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1434 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1435 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1436 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1437
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001438maxconn <number>
1439 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1440 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1441 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001442 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1443 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1444 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1445 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001446 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1447 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1448 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1449 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1450 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1451 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001452
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001453maxconnrate <number>
1454 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1455 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1456 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1457 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1458 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1459 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1460 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1461 fairness.
1462
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001463maxcomprate <number>
1464 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001465 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001466 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1467 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1468 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001469 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001470 default value.
1471
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001472maxcompcpuusage <number>
1473 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1474 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1475 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1476 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1477 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1478 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1479 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1480 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1481
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001482maxpipes <number>
1483 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1484 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1485 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1486 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1487 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1488 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1489
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001490maxsessrate <number>
1491 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1492 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1493 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1494 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1495 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1496 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1497 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1498 fairness.
1499
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001500maxsslconn <number>
1501 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1502 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1503 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1504 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1505 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1506 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1507 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001508 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1509 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1510 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1511 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1512 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1513 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1514 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001515
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001516maxsslrate <number>
1517 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1518 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1519 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1520 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1521 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1522 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1523 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1524 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1525 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1526 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1527
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001528maxzlibmem <number>
1529 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1530 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1531 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001532 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1533 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1534 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1535
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001536noepoll
1537 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1538 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001539 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001540
1541nokqueue
1542 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1543 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1544 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1545
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001546noevports
1547 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1548 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1549 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1550 also "nopoll".
1551
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001552nopoll
1553 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1554 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001555 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001556 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1557 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001558
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001559nosplice
1560 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001561 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001562 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001563 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001564 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1565 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1566 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1567 "option splice-response".
1568
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001569nogetaddrinfo
1570 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1571 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1572
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001573noreuseport
1574 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1575 command line argument "-dR".
1576
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001577profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1578 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1579 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1580 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1581 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001582 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001583 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1584 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1585 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1586 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1587
1588 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1589 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1590 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1591 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1592 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001593 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1594 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1595 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1596 CLI.
1597
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001598spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001599 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1600 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1601 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1602 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1603 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1604 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001605
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001606ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001607 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001608 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001609 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1610 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1611 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1612 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1613 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001614 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1615 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001616 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1617 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1618 openssl configuration file uses:
1619 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1620
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001621ssl-mode-async
1622 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001623 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001624 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1625 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1626 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001627 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001628 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001629
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001630tune.buffers.limit <number>
1631 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1632 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1633 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1634 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1635 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001636 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001637 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1638 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1639 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1640 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1641 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1642 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1643 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1644 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1645 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1646
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001647tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1648 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1649 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1650 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1651 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1652
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001653tune.bufsize <number>
1654 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1655 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1656 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1657 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1658 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1659 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1660 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001661 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1662 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1663 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001664 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001665 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1666 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1667 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001668
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001669tune.chksize <number>
1670 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1671 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1672 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1673 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1674 checks whenever possible.
1675
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001676tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1677 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1678 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1679 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1680 this value. The default value is 1.
1681
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001682tune.fail-alloc
1683 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1684 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1685 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1686 gracefully.
1687
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001688tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1689 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1690 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1691 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1692 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1693 change it.
1694
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001695tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1696 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001697 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1698 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001699 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1700 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1701 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1702 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1703 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1704
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001705tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1706 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1707 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1708 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1709 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1710 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1711 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1712 recommended not to change this value.
1713
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001714tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1715 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1716 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1717 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1718 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1719 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1720 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1721 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1722
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001723tune.http.cookielen <number>
1724 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1725 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1726 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1727 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1728 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1729 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1730 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1731 to change this value.
1732
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001733tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001734 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1735 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001736 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001737 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001738 configuration directives too.
1739 The default value is 1024.
1740
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001741tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1742 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1743 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1744 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1745 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1746 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1747 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001748 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1749 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1750 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001751
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001752tune.idletimer <timeout>
1753 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1754 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1755 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1756 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1757 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1758 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001759 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001760 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001761 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1762
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001763tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1764 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1765 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1766 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1767 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1768 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1769 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1770 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1771 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1772 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1773
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001774tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1775 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001776 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001777 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1778 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001779 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001780 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1781 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1782
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001783tune.lua.maxmem
1784 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1785 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1786 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1787 memory.
1788
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001789tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1790 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001791 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1792 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001793 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001794
1795tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1796 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1797 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1798 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1799 check servers.
1800
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001801tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1802 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1803 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1804 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001805 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001806
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001807tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001808 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1809 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1810 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1811 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1812 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1813 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1814 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1815 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1816 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1817 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001818
1819tune.maxpollevents <number>
1820 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1821 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1822 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1823 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1824 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1825
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001826tune.maxrewrite <number>
1827 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1828 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1829 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1830 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1831 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1832 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1833 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1834 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1835 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1836 bufsize.
1837
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001838tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1839 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1840 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1841 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1842 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1843 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1844 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1845 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1846 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1847 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001848 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1849 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001850 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1851 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1852 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1853 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1854 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1855 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1856 setting this parameter to 0.
1857
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001858tune.pipesize <number>
1859 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1860 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1861 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1862 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1863 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1864 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1865
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001866tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1867 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1868 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1869 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1870 default is 20.
1871
1872tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1873 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1874 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1875 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1876 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1877 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1878 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001879 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001880
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001881tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1882tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1883 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1884 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1885 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001886 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001887 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001888 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1889 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1890
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001891tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001892 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001893 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1894 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1895 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1896 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1897
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001898tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001899 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001900 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1901 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1902
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001903tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1904tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1905 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1906 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1907 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001908 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001909 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001910 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1911 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1912 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1913 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1914 notifying haproxy again.
1915
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001916tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001917 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1918 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1919 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001920 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001921 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001922 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001923 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1924 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1925 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001926 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1927 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001928
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001929tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001930 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001931 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1932 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1933 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1934 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1935 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1936
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001937tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1938 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001939 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001940 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1941 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1942 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1943 being used for too long.
1944
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001945tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1946 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1947 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1948 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1949 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1950 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1951 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1952 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1953 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1954 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1955 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001956 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001957 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001958
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001959tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1960 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1961 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1962 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1963 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1964 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1965 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1966 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001967 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1968 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001969
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001970tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1971 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1972 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1973 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1974 1000 entries.
1975
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001976tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1977 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1978 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1979 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1980
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001981tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001982tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001983tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1984tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1985tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001986 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1987 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1988 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1989 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1990 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1991 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1992 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1993 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001994
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001995 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1996 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1997 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1998 all available space is consumed.
1999 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2000 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2001 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002002
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002003tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2004 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002005 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002006 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002007 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002008 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2009
2010tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2011 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2012 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002013 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2014 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020163.3. Debugging
2017--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002018
2019debug
2020 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2021 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2022 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2023 system startup.
2024
2025quiet
2026 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2027 line argument "-q".
2028
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002029
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020303.4. Userlists
2031--------------
2032It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2033http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2034it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2035
2036userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002037 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002038 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2039
2040group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002041 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002042 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2043 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2044
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002045user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2046 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002047 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2048 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002049 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2050 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2051 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2052 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002053
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002054 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2055 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2056 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2057 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2058 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2059 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2060 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2061 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2062 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002063
2064 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002065 userlist L1
2066 group G1 users tiger,scott
2067 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002068
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002069 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2070 user scott insecure-password elgato
2071 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002072
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002073 userlist L2
2074 group G1
2075 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002076
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002077 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2078 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2079 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002080
2081 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002082
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002083
20843.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002085----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002086It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2087several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2088instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2089values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2090automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2091In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2092using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2093tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2094reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2095Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2096that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2097each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002098
2099peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002100 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002101 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2102
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002103bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2104 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2105 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2106
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002107disabled
2108 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2109 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2110 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2111
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002112default-bind [param*]
2113 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2114
2115default-server [param*]
2116 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2117
2118 Arguments:
2119 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2120 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2121 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2122 details.
2123
2124
2125 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2126
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002127enable
2128 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2129
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002130peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002131 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2132 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2133 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2134 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2135 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2136 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2137
2138 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2139 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2140
2141 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2142 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2143 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2144 across all peers.
2145
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002146 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2147 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002148
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002149 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2150 "server" keyword explanation below).
2151
2152server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002153 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002154 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2155 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2156 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2157 of this "peers" section).
2158 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2159
2160
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002161 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002162 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002163 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002164 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2165 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2166 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002167
2168 backend mybackend
2169 mode tcp
2170 balance roundrobin
2171 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2172 stick on src
2173
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002174 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2175 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002176
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002177 Example:
2178 peers mypeers
2179 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2180 default-server ssl verify none
2181 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2182 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002183
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002184
2185table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2186 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2187
2188 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2189 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002190 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002191 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2192 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2193 "stick-table" keyword).
2194
2195 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2196 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2197 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2198 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2199 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2200 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2201 of the stick-table name as follows:
2202
2203 peers mypeers
2204 peer A ...
2205 peer B ...
2206 table t1 ...
2207
2208 frontend fe1
2209 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2210
2211 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2212 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2213
2214 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2215 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2216 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2217 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2218 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2219 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2220 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2221
2222 peers mypeers
2223 peer A ...
2224 peer B ...
2225 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2226
2227 backend t1
2228 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2229
2230 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2231 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2232 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2233
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090022343.6. Mailers
2235------------
2236It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2237If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2238in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2239
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002240mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002241 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2242 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2243
2244mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2245 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2246
2247 Example:
2248 mailers mymailers
2249 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2250 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2251
2252 backend mybackend
2253 mode tcp
2254 balance roundrobin
2255
2256 email-alert mailers mymailers
2257 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2258 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2259
2260 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2261 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2262
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002263timeout mail <time>
2264 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2265 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2266 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2267 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2268
2269 Example:
2270 mailers mymailers
2271 timeout mail 20s
2272 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002273
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020022743.7. Programs
2275-------------
2276In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2277master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2278managed the same way as the workers.
2279
2280During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2281sequence as a worker:
2282
2283 - the master is re-executed
2284 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2285 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2286 instance of the program
2287
2288During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2289
2290program <name>
2291 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2292 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2293 the management guide).
2294
2295command <command> [arguments*]
2296 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2297 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2298 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2299 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2300
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002301user <user name>
2302 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2303 See also "group".
2304
2305group <group name>
2306 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2307 See also "user".
2308
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002309option start-on-reload
2310no option start-on-reload
2311 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2312 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2313 program section.
2314
2315
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023164. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002317----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002318
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002319Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002320 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002321 - frontend <name>
2322 - backend <name>
2323 - listen <name>
2324
2325A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2326its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2327section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002328section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002329
2330A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2331connections.
2332
2333A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2334to forward incoming connections.
2335
2336A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2337parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2338
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002339All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2340'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2341case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2342
2343Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2344logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2345proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2346However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2347name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2348
2349Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2350and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002351bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002352protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2353modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2354arbitrary criteria.
2355
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002356In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2357a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002358the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002359
2360 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2361 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2362 between responses and new requests.
2363
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002364 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2365 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2366 client-facing connection remains open.
2367
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002368 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2369 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002370
2371The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2372frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2373following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002374weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002375
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002376 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002377
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002378 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2379 ----+-----+-----+----
2380 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2381 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002382 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2383 ----+-----+-----+----
2384 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002385
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002386
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002387
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023884.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2389--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002390
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002391The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2392limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2393they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2394limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002395marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002396option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002397and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2398with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2399specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002400
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002401
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002402 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2403------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2404acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002405backlog X X X -
2406balance X - X X
2407bind - X X -
2408bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002409capture cookie - X X -
2410capture request header - X X -
2411capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002412compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002413cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002414declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002415default-server X - X X
2416default_backend X X X -
2417description - X X X
2418disabled X X X X
2419dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002420email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002421email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002422email-alert mailers X X X X
2423email-alert myhostname X X X X
2424email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002425enabled X X X X
2426errorfile X X X X
2427errorloc X X X X
2428errorloc302 X X X X
2429-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2430errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002431force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002432filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002433fullconn X - X X
2434grace X X X X
2435hash-type X - X X
2436http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002437http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002438http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002439http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002440http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002441http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002442http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002443id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002444ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002445load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002446log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002447log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002448log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002449log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002450max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002451maxconn X X X -
2452mode X X X X
2453monitor fail - X X -
2454monitor-net X X X -
2455monitor-uri X X X -
2456option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2457option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2458option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2459option allbackups (*) X - X X
2460option checkcache (*) X - X X
2461option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2462option contstats (*) X X X -
2463option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2464option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002465-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2466option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002467option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2468option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002469option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002470option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002471option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002472option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002473option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002474option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2475option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2476option httpchk X - X X
2477option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002478option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002479option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002480option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002481option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002482option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002483option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2484option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2485option logasap (*) X X X -
2486option mysql-check X - X X
2487option nolinger (*) X X X X
2488option originalto X X X X
2489option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002490option pgsql-check X - X X
2491option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002492option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002493option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002494option smtpchk X - X X
2495option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2496option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2497option splice-request (*) X X X X
2498option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002499option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002500option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2501option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2502-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002503option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002504option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2505option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2506option tcpka X X X X
2507option tcplog X X X X
2508option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002509external-check command X - X X
2510external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002511persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2512rate-limit sessions X X X -
2513redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002514-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002515retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002516retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002517server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002518server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002519server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002520source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002521stats admin - X X X
2522stats auth X X X X
2523stats enable X X X X
2524stats hide-version X X X X
2525stats http-request - X X X
2526stats realm X X X X
2527stats refresh X X X X
2528stats scope X X X X
2529stats show-desc X X X X
2530stats show-legends X X X X
2531stats show-node X X X X
2532stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002533-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2534stick match - - X X
2535stick on - - X X
2536stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002537stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002538stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002539tcp-check connect - - X X
2540tcp-check expect - - X X
2541tcp-check send - - X X
2542tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002543tcp-request connection - X X -
2544tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002545tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002546tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002547tcp-response content - - X X
2548tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002549timeout check X - X X
2550timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002551timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002552timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002553timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2554timeout http-request X X X X
2555timeout queue X - X X
2556timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002557timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002558timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002559timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002560transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002561unique-id-format X X X -
2562unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002563use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002564use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002565use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002566------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2567 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002568
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002569
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025704.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2571---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002572
2573This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2574
2575
2576acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2577 Declare or complete an access list.
2578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2579 no | yes | yes | yes
2580 Example:
2581 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2582 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2583 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2584
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002585 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002586
2587
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002588backlog <conns>
2589 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2591 yes | yes | yes | no
2592 Arguments :
2593 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2594 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002595 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002596
2597 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2598 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2599 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2600 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2601 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2602 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2603 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2604 backlog parameter.
2605
2606 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2607 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2608 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2609
2610 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2611
2612
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002613balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002614balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002615 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2617 yes | no | yes | yes
2618 Arguments :
2619 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2620 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2621 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2622 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2623
2624 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2625 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2626 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2627 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002628 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002629 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002630 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2631 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2632 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2633 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2634 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2635 it, so that you don't worry.
2636
2637 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2638 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2639 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2640 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2641 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2642 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2643 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2644 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002645
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002646 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2647 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2648 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2649 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2650 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2651 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2652 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2653 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2654
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002655 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002656 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002657 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2658 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002659 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002660 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2661 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2662 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2663 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2664 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002665 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2666 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2667 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2668 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2669 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2670 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002671
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002672 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2673 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2674 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2675 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2676 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2677 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2678 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2679 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002680 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002681 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002682 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2683 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2684 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002685
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002686 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2687 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2688 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2689 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2690 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2691 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2692 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2693 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2694 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2695 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2696 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2697 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002698
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002699 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002700 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2701 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2702 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2703 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2704 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2705 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2706 URIs start with a leading "/".
2707
2708 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2709 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2710 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2711 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2712
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002713 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002714 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2715
2716 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002717 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2718 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002719 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2720 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2721 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2722 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002723 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002724 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2725 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002726
2727 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2728 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2729 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2730 server will receive the request.
2731
2732 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2733 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2734 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2735 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2736 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002737 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2738 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2739 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002740
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002741 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2742 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2743 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2744 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2745 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002746
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002747 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002748 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2749 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2750 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2751
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002752 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2753 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2754 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2755
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002756 random
2757 random(<draws>)
2758 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002759 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2760 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2761 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2762 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002763 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2764 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2765 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2766 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2767 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2768 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2769 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2770 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2771 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2772 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2773 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2774 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2775 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2776 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2777 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2778 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2779 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2780 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2781 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2782 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002783
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002784 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002785 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002786 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2787 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2788 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2789 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2790 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2791 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002792 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002793 used instead.
2794
2795 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2796 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2797 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2798 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2799
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002800 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2801 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2802 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2803
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002804 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002805
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002806 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002807 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2808 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002809
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002810 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2811 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2812 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002813
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002814 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002815 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002816 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2817 NTLM relies on.
2818
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002819 Examples :
2820 balance roundrobin
2821 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002822 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002823 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2824 balance hdr(host)
2825 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002826
2827 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2828 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2829
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002830 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002831 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2832 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2833 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02002834 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002835
2836 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2837 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2838 defaults to 16 kB.
2839
2840 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2841 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2842
2843 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2844 Round Robin.
2845
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002846 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002847 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2848 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2849 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2850
2851 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2852
2853 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002854 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002855 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2856 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2857 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002858
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002859 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002860
2861
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002862bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2863bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002864 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2866 no | yes | yes | no
2867 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002868 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2869 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2870 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2871 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002872 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002873 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2874 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2875 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2876 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2877 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2878 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2879 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002880 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2881 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2882 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2883 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2884 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2885 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2886 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002887 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2888 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2889 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002890 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2891 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2892 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2893 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002894 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2895 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2896 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002897
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002898 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2899 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002900 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2901 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2902 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002903 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2904 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2905 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2906 the range.
2907
2908 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2909 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2910 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2911 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2912 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2913 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2914 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002915 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002916 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002917
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002918 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002919 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002920 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2921 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2922 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2923 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2924 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2925 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2926
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002927 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2928 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2929 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2930 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002931
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002932 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2933 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2934 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2935 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2936 in a frontend.
2937
2938 Example :
2939 listen http_proxy
2940 bind :80,:443
2941 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002942 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002943
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002944 listen http_https_proxy
2945 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002946 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002947
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002948 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2949 bind ipv6@:80
2950 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2951 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2952
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002953 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002954 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002955
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002956 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2957 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2958 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2959 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2960 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2961
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002962 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002963 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002964
2965
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002966bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002967 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2969 yes | yes | yes | yes
2970 Arguments :
2971 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2972 may be used to override a default value.
2973
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002974 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002975 option may be combined with other numbers.
2976
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002977 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002978 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2979 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2980 missing from all processes.
2981
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002982 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002983 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002984 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2985 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2986 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2987 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2988 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002989 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002990
2991 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2992 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2993 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2994 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2995 and 'even' instances.
2996
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002997 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2998 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2999 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3000 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003001
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003002 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3003 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3004
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003005 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3006 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3007 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3008
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003009 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3010 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3011
3012 Example :
3013 listen app_ip1
3014 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003015 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003016
3017 listen app_ip2
3018 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003019 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003020
3021 listen management
3022 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003023 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003024
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003025 listen management
3026 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3027 bind-process 1-4
3028
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003029 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003030
3031
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003032capture cookie <name> len <length>
3033 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3035 no | yes | yes | no
3036 Arguments :
3037 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3038 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3039 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3040 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003041 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003042
3043 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3044 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3045 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3046 right if it exceeds <length>.
3047
3048 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3049 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3050 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3051 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3052
3053 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3054 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3055 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3056
3057 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3058 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3059 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003060 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3061 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3062 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003063
3064 Example:
3065 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3066
3067 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003068 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003069
3070
3071capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003072 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3074 no | yes | yes | no
3075 Arguments :
3076 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003077 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003078 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3079 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3080 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3081
3082 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3083 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3084 it exceeds <length>.
3085
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003086 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003087 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3088 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003089 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3090 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3091 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3092 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003093 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003094 environments to find where the request came from.
3095
3096 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3097 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3098 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3099 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003100
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003101 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3102 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3103 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3104 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3105 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003106
3107 Example:
3108 capture request header Host len 15
3109 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003110 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003111
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003112 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003113 about logging.
3114
3115
3116capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003117 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3119 no | yes | yes | no
3120 Arguments :
3121 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003122 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003123 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3124 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3125 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3126
3127 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3128 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3129 it exceeds <length>.
3130
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003131 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003132 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3133 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3134 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003135 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3136 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3137 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3138 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003139
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003140 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3141 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3142 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3143 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3144 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003145
3146 Example:
3147 capture response header Content-length len 9
3148 capture response header Location len 15
3149
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003150 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003151 about logging.
3152
3153
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003154compression algo <algorithm> ...
3155compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003156compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003157 Enable HTTP compression.
3158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3159 yes | yes | yes | yes
3160 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003161 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3162 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3163 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3164
3165 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003166 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3167 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3168 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003169
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003170 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003171 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003172
3173 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3174 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3175 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3176 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3177 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003178 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003179
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003180 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3181 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3182 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3183 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3184 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3185 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3186 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003187 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003188
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003189 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003190 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003191 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3192 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3193 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3194 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3195 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003196
3197 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3198 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3199 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3200 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3201 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003202 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3203 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3204 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3205 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3206 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003207 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3208 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003209
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003210 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003211 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3212 "Accept-Encoding" header
3213 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003214 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003215 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3216 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3217 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3218 "multipart"
3219 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3220 header
3221 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3222 and later
3223 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3224 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003225 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003226
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003227 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003228
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003229 Examples :
3230 compression algo gzip
3231 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003232
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003233
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003234cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003235 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3236 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003237 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003238 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3240 yes | no | yes | yes
3241 Arguments :
3242 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3243 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3244 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3245 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3246 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3247 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003248 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003249 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3250 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3251
3252 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3253 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3254 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3255 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3256 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3257 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003258 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3259 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003260 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003261 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3262 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003263
3264 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003265 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003266
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003267 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003268 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003269 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003270 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003271 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3272 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3273 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3274 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3275 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3276 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3277 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003278
3279 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3280 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3281 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3282 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3283 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3284 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3285 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3286 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3287 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003288 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003289 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3290 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3291 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003292
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003293 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3294 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3295 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003296 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3297 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3298 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3299 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003300 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3301 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3302 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003303
3304 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3305 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3306 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3307 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3308 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3309 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3310 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3311 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3312 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3313
3314 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3315 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3316 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3317 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3318 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3319 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3320 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3321 persistence cookie in the cache.
3322 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3323
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003324 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3325 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3326 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3327 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3328 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003329 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003330 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3331 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3332 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3333 they logout.
3334
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003335 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3336 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3337 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3338 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3339
3340 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3341 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3342 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3343 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3344 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3345 this attribute.
3346
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003347 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003348 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003349 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3350 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3351 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3352 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3353 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3354 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003355
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003356 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3357 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3358 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3359 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3360 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3361 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3362 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3363 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003364 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003365 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3366 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3367 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3368 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3369 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3370 the site.
3371
3372 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3373 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3374 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3375 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3376 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3377 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3378 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3379 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3380 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3381 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3382 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3383 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3384 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003385 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003386 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3387 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3388
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003389 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3390 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3391 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3392 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3393 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3394 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3395
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003396 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3397 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3398 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3399 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003401 Examples :
3402 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3403 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3404 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003405 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003406
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003407 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003408
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003409
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003410declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3411 Declares a capture slot.
3412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3413 no | yes | yes | no
3414 Arguments:
3415 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3416
3417 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3418 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3419 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3420 for use in the response.
3421
3422 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003423 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003424 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3425
3426
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003427default-server [param*]
3428 Change default options for a server in a backend
3429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3430 yes | no | yes | yes
3431 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003432 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3433 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3434 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3435 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003436
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003437 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003438 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3439
3440 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003441
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003442
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003443default_backend <backend>
3444 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3446 yes | yes | yes | no
3447 Arguments :
3448 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3449
3450 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3451 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3452 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3453 will catch all undetermined requests.
3454
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003455 Example :
3456
3457 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3458 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3459 default_backend dynamic
3460
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003461 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003462
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003463
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003464description <string>
3465 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3467 no | yes | yes | yes
3468 Arguments : string
3469
3470 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3471 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3472 it describes.
3473 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3474
3475
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003476disabled
3477 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3479 yes | yes | yes | yes
3480 Arguments : none
3481
3482 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3483 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3484 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3485 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3486 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3487 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3488 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3489
3490 See also : "enabled"
3491
3492
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003493dispatch <address>:<port>
3494 Set a default server address
3495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3496 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003497 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003498
3499 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3500 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3501 during start-up.
3502
3503 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3504 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3505 possible with normal servers.
3506
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003507 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003508 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3509 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3510 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3511 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3512
3513 See also : "server"
3514
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003515
3516dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3517 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3519 yes | no | yes | yes
3520 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3521
3522 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003523 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003524 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3525 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003526 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003527 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003528
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003529enabled
3530 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3532 yes | yes | yes | yes
3533 Arguments : none
3534
3535 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3536 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3537
3538 See also : "disabled"
3539
3540
3541errorfile <code> <file>
3542 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3544 yes | yes | yes | yes
3545 Arguments :
3546 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003547 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3548 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003549
3550 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003551 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003552 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003553 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3554 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003555
3556 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3557 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3558 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3559
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003560 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3561
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003562 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3563 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3564 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3565 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3566
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003567 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3568 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003569 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003570 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3571 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3572 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3573
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003574 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3575 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3576 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003577 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003578 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3579
3580 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3581
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003582 Example :
3583 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003584 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003585 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3586 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3587
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003588
3589errorloc <code> <url>
3590errorloc302 <code> <url>
3591 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3593 yes | yes | yes | yes
3594 Arguments :
3595 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003596 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3597 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003598
3599 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3600 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3601 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3602 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003603 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003604
3605 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3606 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3607 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3608
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003609 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3610
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003611 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3612 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3613 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3614 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003615 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003616 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3617 request.
3618
3619 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3620
3621
3622errorloc303 <code> <url>
3623 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3625 yes | yes | yes | yes
3626 Arguments :
3627 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003628 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3629 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003630
3631 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3632 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3633 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3634 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003635 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003636
3637 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3638 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3639 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3640
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003641 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3642
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003643 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3644 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3645 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3646 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003647 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003648
3649 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3650
3651
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003652email-alert from <emailaddr>
3653 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003654 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003655 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3656 yes | yes | yes | yes
3657
3658 Arguments :
3659
3660 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3661
3662 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3663 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3664
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003665 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003666 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3667 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003668
3669
3670email-alert level <level>
3671 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3672 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3673 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3674 yes | yes | yes | yes
3675
3676 Arguments :
3677
3678 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3679 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3680 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3681
3682 By default level is alert
3683
3684 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3685 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3686 for the proxy.
3687
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003688 Alerts are sent when :
3689
3690 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3691 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3692 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3693 is notice or lower
3694 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3695 and a health check status update occurs
3696
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003697 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3698 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003699 section 3.6 about mailers.
3700
3701
3702email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3703 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3704 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3705 yes | yes | yes | yes
3706
3707 Arguments :
3708
3709 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3710
3711 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3712 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3713
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003714 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3715 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003716
3717
3718email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3719 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3720 mailers.
3721 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3722 yes | yes | yes | yes
3723
3724 Arguments :
3725
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003726 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003727
3728 By default the systems hostname is used.
3729
3730 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3731 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3732 for the proxy.
3733
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003734 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3735 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003736
3737
3738email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003739 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003740 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3741 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3742 yes | yes | yes | yes
3743
3744 Arguments :
3745
3746 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3747
3748 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3749 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3750
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003751 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003752 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3753
3754
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003755force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3756 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3757 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003758 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003759
3760 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3761 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3762 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3763 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3764 marked down for maintenance operations.
3765
3766 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3767 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3768 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3769 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3770 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3771 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3772 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3773 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3774 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3775
3776 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3777 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3778 is used.
3779
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003780 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003781 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003782
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003783
3784filter <name> [param*]
3785 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3787 no | yes | yes | yes
3788 Arguments :
3789 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3790 referenced in section 9.
3791
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003792 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003793 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003794 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3795 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003796
3797 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3798 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3799
3800 Example:
3801 listen
3802 bind *:80
3803
3804 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3805 filter compression
3806 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3807
3808 compression algo gzip
3809 compression offload
3810
3811 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3812
3813 See also : section 9.
3814
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003815
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003816fullconn <conns>
3817 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3819 yes | no | yes | yes
3820 Arguments :
3821 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3822 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3823
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003824 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003825 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003826 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003827 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3828 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3829 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3830 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3831 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003832 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003833
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003834 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3835 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003836 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3837 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3838 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003839
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003840 Example :
3841 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3842 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3843 # connections.
3844 backend dynamic
3845 fullconn 10000
3846 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3847 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3848
3849 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3850
3851
3852grace <time>
3853 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003855 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003856 Arguments :
3857 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3858 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3859 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3860
3861 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3862 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003863 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003864 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3865
3866 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3867 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3868 simplify it.
3869
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003870
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003871hash-balance-factor <factor>
3872 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3874 yes | no | no | yes
3875 Arguments :
3876 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3877 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003878 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003879
3880 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3881 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3882 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3883 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3884 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3885 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3886 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3887
3888 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3889 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3890 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3891 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3892 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3893
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003894 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3895 consistent hashing mechanism.
3896
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003897 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3898
3899
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003900hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003901 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3903 yes | no | yes | yes
3904 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003905 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3906 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003907
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003908 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3909 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3910 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3911 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3912 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3913 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3914 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3915 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3916 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3917 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003918
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003919 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3920 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3921 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3922 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3923 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3924 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3925 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3926 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3927 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3928 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3929 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3930 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3931 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003932 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3933 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003934
3935 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3936
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003937 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003938 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3939 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3940 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003941 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3942 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3943 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003944
3945 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3946 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003947 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3948 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3949 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3950 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3951
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003952 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3953 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3954 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3955 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3956 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3957 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3958 parameter.
3959
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003960 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3961 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3962 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3963 used on strings.
3964
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003965 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3966
3967 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3968 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3969 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3970 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3971 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3972 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3973 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3974 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3975 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3976 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3977 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3978 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003979
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003980 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3981 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3982 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003983
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003984 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003985
3986
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003987http-check disable-on-404
3988 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003990 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003991 Arguments : none
3992
3993 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3994 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3995 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3996 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3997 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3998 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3999 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4000 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004001 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4002 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4003 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4004
4005 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4006
4007
4008http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004009 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004011 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004012 Arguments :
4013 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4014 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004015 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004016 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4017 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4018 details on the supported keywords.
4019
4020 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4021 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4022 with the usual backslash ('\').
4023
4024 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4025 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4026 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4027 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4028 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4029
4030 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004031 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004032 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4033 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4034 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4035
4036 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004037 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004038 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4039 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4040 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4041 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4042
4043 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004044 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004045 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4046 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4047 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4048 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4049 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004050 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004051 trace).
4052
4053 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004054 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004055 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4056 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4057 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4058 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4059 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004060 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004061
4062 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4063 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4064 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4065 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4066 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4067 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4068 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4069 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4070
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004071 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4072 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4073 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4074
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004075 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4076 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4077
4078 Examples :
4079 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004080 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004081
4082 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004083 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004084
4085 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004086 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004087
4088 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004089 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004090
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004091 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004092
4093
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004094http-check send-state
4095 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4097 yes | no | yes | yes
4098 Arguments : none
4099
4100 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4101 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4102 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4103 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4104 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4105
4106 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4107 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4108 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4109 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4110 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004111 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4112 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4113 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4114
4115 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4116 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4117 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4118
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004119 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4120 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4121 checked in multiple backends.
4122
4123 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4124 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4125
4126 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4127 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4128 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4129 one fails.
4130
4131 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4132 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4133 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4134
4135 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4136 server's queue.
4137
4138 Example of a header received by the application server :
4139 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4140 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4141
4142 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4143
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004144
4145http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004146 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4147
4148 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4149 no | yes | yes | yes
4150
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004151 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4152 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4153 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4154 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4155 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004156
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004157 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4158 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004159
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004160 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004161
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004162 Example:
4163 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4164 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4165 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004166
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004167 http-request allow if nagios
4168 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4169 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4170 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004171
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004172 Example:
4173 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4174 acl add path /addacl
4175 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004176
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004177 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004178
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004179 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4180 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004181
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004182 Example:
4183 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4184 acl setmap path /setmap
4185 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004186
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004187 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004188
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004189 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4190 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004191
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004192 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4193 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004194
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004195http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004196
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004197 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4198 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4199 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4200 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4201 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4202 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4203 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4204 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004205
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004206http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004207
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004208 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4209 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4210 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4211 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4212 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4213 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4214 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4215 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004216
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004217http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004218
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004219 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4220 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004221
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004222
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004223http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004224
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004225 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4226 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4227 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4228 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4229 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004230
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004231 Example:
4232 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4233 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004234
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004235http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004236
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004237 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004238
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004239http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4240 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004241
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004242 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4243 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4244 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4245 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4246 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4247 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4248 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4249 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4250 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004251
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004252 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4253 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4254 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4255 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4256 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4257 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004258
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004259http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004260
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004261 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4262 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4263 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4264 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4265 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4266 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004267
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004268http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004269
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004270 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004271
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004272http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004273
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004274 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4275 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4276 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4277 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4278 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4279 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004280
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004281http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004282
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004283 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4284 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4285 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4286 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4287 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004288
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004289http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4290 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4291 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4292 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4293
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004294http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4295
4296 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4297 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4298 pointed by <resolvers>.
4299 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4300 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4301 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4302 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4303 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4304 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4305 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4306 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4307 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4308 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4309 to 0.0.0.0.
4310
4311 Example:
4312 resolvers mydns
4313 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4314 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4315 timeout retry 1s
4316 hold valid 10s
4317 hold nx 3s
4318 hold other 3s
4319 hold obsolete 0s
4320 accepted_payload_size 8192
4321
4322 frontend fe
4323 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4324 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4325 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4326
4327 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4328 # which mean DNS resolution error
4329 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4330
4331 default_backend be
4332
4333 backend b_503
4334 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4335 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4336 # 503 error page to end users
4337
4338 backend be
4339 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4340 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4341 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4342 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4343 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4344
4345 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4346 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4347
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004348http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4349
4350 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4351 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4352 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4353 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004354 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4355 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004356
4357 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4358
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004359http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004360
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004361 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4362 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4363 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4364 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4365 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004366
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004367http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004368
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004369 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4370 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4371 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4372 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004373
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004374http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4375 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004376
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004377 This matches the value of all occurences of header field <name> against
4378 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4379 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4380 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4381 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4382 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004383
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004384 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4385 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4386 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4387 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4388 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004389
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004390 Example:
4391 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4392
4393 # applied to:
4394 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4395
4396 # outputs:
4397 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4398
4399 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004400
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004401 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4402
4403 # applied to:
4404 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004405
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004406 # outputs:
4407 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004408
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004409http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4410 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4411
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004412 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4413 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4414 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4415 against.
4416
4417 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4418 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4419 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004420
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004421 Example:
4422 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4423 http-request replace-uri (.*) /foo\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004424
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004425 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4426 http-request replace-uri ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004427
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004428 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4429 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1
4430 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4431 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004432
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004433http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4434 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004435
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004436 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4437 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4438 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4439 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004440
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004441 Example:
4442 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004443
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004444 # applied to:
4445 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004446
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004447 # outputs:
4448 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004449
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004450http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4451http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004452
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004453 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4454 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4455 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004456
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004457http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004458
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004459 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4460 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4461 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004462
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004463http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004464
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004465 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4466 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4467 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4468 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4469 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004470
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004471 Arguments:
4472 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4473 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004474
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004475 Example:
4476 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4477 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004478
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004479 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4480 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004481
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004482http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004483
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004484 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4485 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4486 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004487
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004488 Arguments:
4489 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4490 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004491
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004492 Example:
4493 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4494 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004495
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004496 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4497 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4498 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004499
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004500http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004501
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004502 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4503 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4504 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4505 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4506 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004507
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004508 Example:
4509 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4510 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4511 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4512 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4513 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4514 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4515 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4516 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4517 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004518
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004519http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004520
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004521 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4522 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4523 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4524 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4525 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004526
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004527http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4528 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004529
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004530 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4531 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4532 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4533 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4534 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4535 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4536 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4537 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4538 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004539
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004540http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004541
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004542 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4543 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4544 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4545 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4546 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4547 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4548 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004549
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004550http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004551
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004552 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4553 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4554 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004555
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004556http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004557
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004558 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4559 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4560 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4561 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4562 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4563 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4564 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4565 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004566
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004567http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004568
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004569 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4570 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4571 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4572 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4573 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4574 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004575
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004576 Example :
4577 # prepend the host name before the path
4578 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004579
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004580http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004581
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004582 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4583 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4584 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4585 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4586 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004587
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004588http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004589
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004590 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4591 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4592 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4593 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4594 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4595 values have higher priority.
4596 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4597 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4598 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4599 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4600 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004601
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004602http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004603
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004604 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4605 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4606 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4607 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4608 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4609 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4610 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004611
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004612 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004613
4614 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004615 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4616 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004617
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004618http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4619 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4620 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4621 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4622 privacy.
4623
4624 Arguments :
4625 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4626 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004627
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004628 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004629 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4630 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4631
4632 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4633 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4634
4635http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4636
4637 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4638 expression.
4639
4640 Arguments:
4641 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4642 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004643
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004644 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004645 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4646 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4647
4648 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4649 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4650 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4651
4652http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4653
4654 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4655 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4656 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4657 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4658 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4659 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4660 information from the request.
4661
4662 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4663
4664http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4665
4666 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4667 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4668 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4669 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4670 path and the query string.
4671 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4672
4673http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4674
4675 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4676 inline.
4677
4678 Arguments:
4679 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4680 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4681 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4682 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4683 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4684 (request and response)
4685 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4686 processing
4687 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4688 processing
4689 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4690 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4691 and '_'.
4692
4693 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4694 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004695
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004696 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004697 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004698
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004699http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4700 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004701
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004702 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4703 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4704 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4705 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4706 agent name must be used.
4707
4708 Arguments:
4709 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4710
4711 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4712 configuration.
4713
4714http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4715
4716 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4717 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4718 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4719 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4720 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4721 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4722 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4723 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4724 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4725 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4726 action.
4727 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4728 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4729 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4730 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4731 you fully understand how it works.
4732
4733http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4734
4735 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4736 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4737 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4738 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4739 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4740 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4741 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4742 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4743 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4744 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4745 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4746 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4747 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4748
4749http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4750http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4751http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4752
4753 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4754 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4755 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4756 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4757 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4758 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4759 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4760 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4761 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4762 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4763 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4764 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4765
4766 Arguments :
4767 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4768 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4769 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4770 select which table entry to update the counters.
4771
4772 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4773 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4774 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4775 that table until the session ends.
4776
4777 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4778 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4779 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4780 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4781 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4782 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4783 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4784 useful information.
4785
4786 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4787 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4788 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4789 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4790 checks that make use of it.
4791
4792http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4793
4794 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004795
4796 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004797 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004798
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004799http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004800
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004801 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4802 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4803 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004804
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004805
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004806http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004807 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4808
4809 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4810 no | yes | yes | yes
4811
4812 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4813 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4814 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4815 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4816 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4817 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4818
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004819 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4820 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004821
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004822 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004823
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004824 Example:
4825 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004826
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004827 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004828
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004829 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4830 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004831
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004832 Example:
4833 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004834
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004835 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004836
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004837 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4838 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004839
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004840 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4841 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004842
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004843http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004844
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004845 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4846 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4847 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4848 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4849 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4850 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4851 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4852 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004853
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004854http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004855
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004856 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4857 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4858 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4859 example, or to pass some internal information.
4860 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4861 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4862 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004863
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004864http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004865
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004866 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4867 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004868
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004869http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004870
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004871 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004872
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004873http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004874
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004875 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4876 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4877 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4878 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4879 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4880 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4881 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004882
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004883 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4884 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4885 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4886 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4887 keyword.
4888 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4889 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004890
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004891http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004892
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004893 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4894 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4895 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4896 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4897 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4898 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004899
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004900http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004901
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004902 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004903
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004904http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004905
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004906 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4907 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4908 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4909 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4910 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4911 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004912
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004913http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004914
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004915 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4916 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004917
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004918http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004919
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004920 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4921 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4922 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4923 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4924 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4925 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004926
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004927http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4928 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004929
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004930 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
4931 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004932
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004933 Example:
4934 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004935
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004936 # applied to:
4937 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004938
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004939 # outputs:
4940 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004941
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004942 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004943
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004944http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4945 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004946
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004947 This works like "http-response replace-value" except that it works on the
4948 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004949
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004950 Example:
4951 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004952
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004953 # applied to:
4954 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004955
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004956 # outputs:
4957 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004958
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004959http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4960http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004961
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004962 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4963 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4964 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004965
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004966http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004967
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004968 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4969 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4970 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004971
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004972http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004973
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004974 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4975 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4976 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4977 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4978 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004979
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004980 Arguments:
4981 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004982
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004983 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4984 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004985
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004986http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004987
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004988 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4989 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4990 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004991
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004992http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4993
4994 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4995 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4996 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4997 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4998 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4999
5000http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5001
5002 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5003 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5004 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5005 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5006 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5007 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5008 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5009 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5010 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5011
5012http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5013
5014 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5015 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5016 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5017 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5018 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5019 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5020 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5021
5022http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5023
5024 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5025 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5026 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5027 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5028 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5029 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5030 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5031 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5032
5033http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5034 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5035
5036 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5037 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5038 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5039 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005040
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005041 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005042 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5043 http-response set-status 431
5044 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5045 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005046
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005047http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005048
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005049 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5050 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5051 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5052 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5053 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5054 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5055 based on some information from the request.
5056
5057 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5058
5059http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5060
5061 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5062 inline.
5063
5064 Arguments:
5065 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5066 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5067 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5068 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5069 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5070 (request and response)
5071 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5072 processing
5073 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5074 processing
5075 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5076 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5077 and '_'.
5078
5079 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5080 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005081
5082 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005083 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005084
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005085http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005086
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005087 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5088 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5089 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5090 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5091 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5092 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5093 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5094 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5095 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5096 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5097 action.
5098 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5099 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5100 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5101 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5102 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005103
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005104http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5105http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5106http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005107
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005108 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5109 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5110 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5111 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5112 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5113 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5114
5115http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5116
5117 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5118 about <var-name>.
5119
5120 Example:
5121 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5122
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005123
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005124http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5125 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5126
5127 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5128 yes | no | yes | yes
5129
5130 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005131 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5132 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5133 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005134
5135 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5136
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005137 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5138 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5139 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5140 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5141 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5142 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5143 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5144 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5145 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5146 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005147
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005148 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5149 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5150 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5151 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5152 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5153 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5154 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5155 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005156
5157 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5158 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5159 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5160 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5161 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5162 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5163 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5164 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005165 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005166 downsides of rare connection failures.
5167
5168 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5169 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5170 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5171 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5172 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5173 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005174 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005175 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5176 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5177 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5178 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5179 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5180
5181 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005182 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5183 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5184 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005185
5186 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005187 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005188
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005189 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5190 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005191
5192 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5193 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5194 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5195
5196 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5197 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5198 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5199
5200 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5201
5202
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005203http-send-name-header [<header>]
5204 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005205 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5206 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005207 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005208 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5209
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005210 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5211 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5212 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5213 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5214 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5215 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5216 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5217 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5218 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5219 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5220 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5221 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5222 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5223 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5224 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5225 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005226
5227 See also : "server"
5228
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005229id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005230 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5232 no | yes | yes | yes
5233 Arguments : none
5234
5235 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5236 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5237 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005238
5239
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005240ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5241 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5242 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005243 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005244
5245 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5246 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5247 and running).
5248
5249 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5250 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5251 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005252 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005253 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5254
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005255 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5256 "unless" condition is met.
5257
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005258 Example:
5259 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5260 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5261 ignore-persist if url_static
5262
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005263 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5264
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005265load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5266 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5267 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5268 yes | no | yes | yes
5269
5270 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5271 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5272 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005273 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005274 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5275 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5276 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5277 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5278
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005279 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005280 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005281 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005282
5283 Arguments:
5284 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5285 named "server-state-file".
5286
5287 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5288 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5289 name is used as a file name.
5290
5291 none don't load any stat for this backend
5292
5293 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005294 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5295 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5296 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005297 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005298 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005299
5300 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5301 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5302
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005303 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005304
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005305 global
5306 stats socket /tmp/socket
5307 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005308
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005309 defaults
5310 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005311
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005312 backend bk
5313 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5314 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005315
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005316
5317 Then one can run :
5318
5319 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5320
5321 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5322
5323 1
5324 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5325 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5326 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5327
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005328 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005329
5330 global
5331 stats socket /tmp/socket
5332 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5333
5334 defaults
5335 load-server-state-from-file local
5336
5337 backend bk
5338 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5339 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5340
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005341
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005342 Then one can run :
5343
5344 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5345
5346 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5347
5348 1
5349 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5350 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5351 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5352
5353 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5354 "show servers state"
5355
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005356
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005357log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005358log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5359 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005360no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005361 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5363 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005364
5365 Prefix :
5366 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5367 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5368 prefix does not allow arguments.
5369
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005370 Arguments :
5371 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5372 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5373 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5374 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5375 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5376 parameter.
5377
5378 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5379 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5380
5381 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5382 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5383 standard syslog port).
5384
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005385 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5386 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5387 standard syslog port).
5388
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005389 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5390 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5391 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005392 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005393
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005394 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5395 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5396 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5397 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5398 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5399 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5400 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5401 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5402 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5403 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5404 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5405 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5406 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5407 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5408 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5409 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005410 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5411 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005412
5413 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5414 and "fd@2", see above.
5415
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02005416 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
5417 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
5418 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
5419 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
5420 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
5421 having the logs instantly available.
5422
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005423 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5424 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005425
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005426 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5427 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5428 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5429 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5430 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5431 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5432 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5433 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5434 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5435 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005436 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005437
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005438 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5439 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5440 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5441 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5442 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5443
5444 <sample_size>
5445 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5446 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5447 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5448 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5449 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5450
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005451 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5452 one of the following :
5453
5454 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5455 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5456
5457 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5458 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5459
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005460 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5461 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5462 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5463 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5464 systemd logger consumes.
5465
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005466 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5467 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5468 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5469 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5470
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005471 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5472
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005473 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5474 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5475 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5476
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005477 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5478 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5479 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5480 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005481
5482 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5483 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5484 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005485 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5486 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5487 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5488 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5489 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005490
5491 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5492
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005493 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5494 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5495 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005496
5497 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5498 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5499 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5500 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5501
5502 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5503 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005504
5505 Example :
5506 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005507 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5508 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5509 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005510 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5511 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005512 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005513
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005514
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005515log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005516 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5517 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5518 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005519
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005520 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5521 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5522 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5523 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5524 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005525
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005526 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5527 "option httplog" directives.
5528
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005529log-format-sd <string>
5530 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5531 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5532 yes | yes | yes | no
5533
5534 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5535 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5536 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5537 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5538 which covers the log format string in depth.
5539
5540 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5541 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5542
5543 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5544 log format to "rfc5424".
5545
5546 Example :
5547 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5548
5549
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005550log-tag <string>
5551 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5552 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5553 yes | yes | yes | yes
5554
5555 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5556 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5557 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5558 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5559 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5560 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5561 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5562 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5563 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005564
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005565max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5566 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5567 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5568 yes | no | yes | yes
5569
5570 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5571 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5572 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5573 servers.
5574
5575 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5576 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5577 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5578 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5579 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005580 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005581 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5582 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5583 picking a different server.
5584
5585 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5586 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5587 even if they have to be queued.
5588
5589 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5590 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5591
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005592max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5593 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5594 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5595 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005596
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005597maxconn <conns>
5598 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5600 yes | yes | yes | no
5601 Arguments :
5602 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5603 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5604 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5605 closes.
5606
5607 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5608 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5609 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5610 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005611 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5612 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5613 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5614 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005615
5616 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5617 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5618 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5619
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005620 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5621 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005622
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005623 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5624
5625
5626mode { tcp|http|health }
5627 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5629 yes | yes | yes | yes
5630 Arguments :
5631 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5632 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5633 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5634 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5635
5636 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5637 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5638 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5639 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5640 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5641
5642 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005643 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5644 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5645 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5646 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5647 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5648 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5649 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005650
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005651 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5652 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5653 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005654
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005655 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005656 defaults http_instances
5657 mode http
5658
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005659 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005660
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005661
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005662monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005663 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5665 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005666 Arguments :
5667 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5668 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005669 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005670 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5671 backend and its backup.
5672
5673 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5674 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5675 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5676 servers in a list of backends.
5677
5678 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5679 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5680 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5681 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5682 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5683 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5684 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005685 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5686 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005687
5688 Example:
5689 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005690 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005691 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5692 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5693 monitor-uri /site_alive
5694 monitor fail if site_dead
5695
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005696 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005697
5698
5699monitor-net <source>
5700 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5702 yes | yes | yes | no
5703 Arguments :
5704 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5705 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5706 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5707 followed by a mask.
5708
5709 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5710 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005711 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005712 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5713
5714 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5715 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5716 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5717 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005718 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5719 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5720 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005721
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005722 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5723 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5724 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5725 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5726 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5727 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005728
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005729 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5730 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005731
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005732 Example :
5733 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5734 frontend www
5735 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5736
5737 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5738
5739
5740monitor-uri <uri>
5741 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5743 yes | yes | yes | no
5744 Arguments :
5745 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5746 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5747
5748 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5749 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5750 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5751 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5752 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5753 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5754 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5755 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5756
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005757 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005758 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
5759 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5760 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5761 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5762 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5763 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005764
5765 Example :
5766 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5767 frontend www
5768 mode http
5769 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5770
5771 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5772
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005773
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005774option abortonclose
5775no option abortonclose
5776 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5778 yes | no | yes | yes
5779 Arguments : none
5780
5781 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5782 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5783 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5784 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005785 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005786 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5787 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5788 encountered while delivering the response.
5789
5790 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5791 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5792 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5793 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5794 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5795 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005796 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005797 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005798 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005799 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5800 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5801 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5802
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005803 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5804 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005805 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5806 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5807 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5808 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5809 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5810 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005811 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005812
5813 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5814 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5815
5816 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5817
5818
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005819option accept-invalid-http-request
5820no option accept-invalid-http-request
5821 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5823 yes | yes | yes | no
5824 Arguments : none
5825
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005826 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005827 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005828 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005829 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5830 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5831 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5832 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5833 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005834 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5835 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5836 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5837 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005838 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005839 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005840 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5841 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5842 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005843
5844 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5845 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5846 been confirmed.
5847
5848 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5849 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005850 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5851 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005852 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5853
5854 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5855 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5856
5857 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5858 stats socket.
5859
5860
5861option accept-invalid-http-response
5862no option accept-invalid-http-response
5863 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5865 yes | no | yes | yes
5866 Arguments : none
5867
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005868 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005869 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005870 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005871 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5872 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5873 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5874 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5875 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005876 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5877 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5878 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005879
5880 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5881 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5882 been confirmed.
5883
5884 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5885 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5886 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5887 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5888
5889 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5890 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5891
5892 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5893 stats socket.
5894
5895
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005896option allbackups
5897no option allbackups
5898 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5900 yes | no | yes | yes
5901 Arguments : none
5902
5903 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5904 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5905 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5906 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5907 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5908 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5909 order between the backup servers anymore.
5910
5911 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5912 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5913
5914 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5915 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5916
5917
5918option checkcache
5919no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005920 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5922 yes | no | yes | yes
5923 Arguments : none
5924
5925 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5926 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005927 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005928 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5929 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005930 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005931
5932 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005933 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005934 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005935 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5936 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005937 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005938 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005939 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5940 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005941 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005942 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5943 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005944 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005945 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5946 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5947 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5948 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5949 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5950 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5951 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5952 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5953 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5954
5955 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005956 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
5957 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
5958 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
5959 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005960
5961 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5962 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005963 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005964 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005965
5966 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5967 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5968
5969
5970option clitcpka
5971no option clitcpka
5972 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5974 yes | yes | yes | no
5975 Arguments : none
5976
5977 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5978 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005979 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005980 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5981
5982 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5983 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5984 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5985 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5986
5987 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5988 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5989 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5990 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5991 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5992
5993 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5994
5995 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5996 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5997 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5998
5999 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6000 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6001
6002 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6003
6004
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006005option contstats
6006 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6008 yes | yes | yes | no
6009 Arguments : none
6010
6011 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6012 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6013 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6014 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006015 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6016 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6017 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6018 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6019 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006020
6021
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006022option dontlog-normal
6023no option dontlog-normal
6024 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6026 yes | yes | yes | no
6027 Arguments : none
6028
6029 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6030 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6031 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6032 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6033 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6034 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6035 logged.
6036
6037 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6038 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6039 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6040
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006041 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006042 logging.
6043
6044
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006045option dontlognull
6046no option dontlognull
6047 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6049 yes | yes | yes | no
6050 Arguments : none
6051
6052 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6053 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6054 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6055 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6056 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6057 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006058 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6059 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6060 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006061
6062 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006063 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006064 would not be logged.
6065
6066 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6067 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6068
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006069 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6070 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006071
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006072
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006073option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006074 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6076 yes | yes | yes | yes
6077 Arguments :
6078 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6079 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006080 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006081 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006082
6083 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6084 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6085 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6086 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6087 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6088 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6089 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006090 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6091 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6092 possible that the client has already brought one.
6093
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006094 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006095 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006096 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006097 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006098 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006099 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006100
6101 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6102 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6103 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6104 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6105 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6106 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6107 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6108
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006109 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6110 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6111 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6112 are under the control of the end-user.
6113
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006114 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006115 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6116 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006117 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6118 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6119 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006120
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006121 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006122 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6123 frontend www
6124 mode http
6125 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6126
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006127 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6128 backend www
6129 mode http
6130 option forwardfor header X-Client
6131
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006132 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006133 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006134
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006135
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006136option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6137no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6138 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6140 yes | yes | yes | no
6141 Arguments : none
6142
6143 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6144 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6145 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6146 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6147 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6148 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6149 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6150
6151 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6152 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6153 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6154 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6155 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6156 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6157 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6158 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6159 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6160 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6161
6162 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6163
6164 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6165 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6166
6167 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6168 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6169
6170
6171option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6172no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6173 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6175 yes | no | yes | yes
6176 Arguments : none
6177
6178 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6179 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6180 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6181 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6182 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6183 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6184 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6185
6186 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6187 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6188 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6189 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6190 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6191 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6192 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6193 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6194 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6195 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6196
6197 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6198
6199 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6200 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6201
6202 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6203 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6204
6205
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006206option http-buffer-request
6207no option http-buffer-request
6208 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6210 yes | yes | yes | yes
6211 Arguments : none
6212
6213 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6214 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6215 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6216 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6217 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6218 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6219 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6220 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006221 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006222 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6223 default.
6224
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006225 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006226
6227
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006228option http-ignore-probes
6229no option http-ignore-probes
6230 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6232 yes | yes | yes | no
6233 Arguments : none
6234
6235 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6236 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6237 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6238 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6239 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6240 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6241 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6242 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6243 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006244 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6245 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006246 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6247
6248 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6249 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6250 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6251 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6252 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6253 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6254 are often the only way to detect them.
6255
6256 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6257 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6258
6259 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6260
6261
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006262option http-keep-alive
6263no option http-keep-alive
6264 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6266 yes | yes | yes | yes
6267 Arguments : none
6268
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006269 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6270 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006271 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6272 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006273 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6274 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6275 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006276
6277 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6278 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006279 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6280 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6281 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6282 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6283 situations where this option may be useful :
6284
6285 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006286 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006287
6288 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6289 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6290
6291 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6292 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6293 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6294 request.
6295
6296 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6297 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006298 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6299 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6300 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006301
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006302 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6303 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6304 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6305 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6306 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6307 not set.
6308
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006309 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6310 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6311 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006312
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006313 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006314 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006315 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006316
6317
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006318option http-no-delay
6319no option http-no-delay
6320 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6322 yes | yes | yes | yes
6323 Arguments : none
6324
6325 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6326 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6327 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6328 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6329 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6330 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6331 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6332 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6333 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6334 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6335 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6336 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6337 affected.
6338
6339 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6340 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6341 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6342 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6343 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6344 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6345 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6346 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6347 latency environments.
6348
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006349 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6350
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006351
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006352option http-pretend-keepalive
6353no option http-pretend-keepalive
6354 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006356 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006357 Arguments : none
6358
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006359 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006360 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6361 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6362 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6363 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6364 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6365 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6366 consider the response complete.
6367
6368 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6369 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6370 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6371 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006372 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006373 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6374
6375 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6376 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6377 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6378 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6379 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6380 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6381 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6382
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006383 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6384 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6385 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6386 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6387 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6388 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006389
6390 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6391 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6392
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006393 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006394 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006395
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006396
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006397option http-server-close
6398no option http-server-close
6399 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6401 yes | yes | yes | yes
6402 Arguments : none
6403
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006404 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6405 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6406 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6407 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006408 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
6409 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
6410 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
6411 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
6412 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
6413 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
6414 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
6415 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
6416 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
6417 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
6418 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006419
6420 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6421 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6422 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6423 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006424 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6425 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006426
6427 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6428 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006429 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6430 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6431 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006432
6433 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6434 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6435
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006436 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6437 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006438
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006439option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006440no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006441 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6443 yes | yes | yes | no
6444 Arguments : none
6445
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006446 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006447 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6448 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6449 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6450 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6451 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6452 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6453
6454 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6455 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006456 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6457 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6458 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006459
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006460 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6461 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6462 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6463 front of an existing proxy.
6464
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006465 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6466
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006467 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006468
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006469option httpchk
6470option httpchk <uri>
6471option httpchk <method> <uri>
6472option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6473 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6475 yes | no | yes | yes
6476 Arguments :
6477 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6478 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6479 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6480 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6481 ones.
6482
6483 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6484 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6485 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6486
6487 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6488 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6489 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6490 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6491 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6492
6493 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6494 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6495 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6496 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6497 the lack of any response.
6498
6499 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6500
6501 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6502 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6503 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6504
6505 Examples :
6506 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6507 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6508 backend https_relay
6509 mode tcp
6510 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6511 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6512
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006513 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6514 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6515 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006516
6517
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006518option httpclose
6519no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006520 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6522 yes | yes | yes | yes
6523 Arguments : none
6524
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006525 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6526 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6527 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6528 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006529 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006530
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006531 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6532 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006533 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006534 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6535 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006536
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006537 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6538 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6539 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006540
6541 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6542 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006543 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
6544 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6545 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006546
6547 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6548 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6549
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006550 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006551
6552
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006553option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006554 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006556 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006557 Arguments :
6558 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6559 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6560 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006561 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006562 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006563
6564 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6565 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6566 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6567 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6568 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6569 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6570 ports.
6571
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006572 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6573 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006574
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006575 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6576
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006577 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006578
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006579
6580option http_proxy
6581no option http_proxy
6582 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6584 yes | yes | yes | yes
6585 Arguments : none
6586
6587 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6588 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6589 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6590 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6591 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6592
6593 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6594 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006595 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6596 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006597
6598 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6599 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6600
6601 Example :
6602 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6603 backend direct_forward
6604 option httpclose
6605 option http_proxy
6606
6607 See also : "option httpclose"
6608
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006609
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006610option independent-streams
6611no option independent-streams
6612 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6614 yes | yes | yes | yes
6615 Arguments : none
6616
6617 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6618 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6619 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6620 receive data or not.
6621
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006622 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006623 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6624 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6625 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6626 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6627 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6628 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6629 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6630 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6631 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6632 socket buffers.
6633
6634 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6635 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6636 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6637 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6638 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6639
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006640 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006641
6642
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006643option ldap-check
6644 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6646 yes | no | yes | yes
6647 Arguments : none
6648
6649 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6650 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6651 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6652 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6653
6654 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6655 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6656
6657 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6658 configure it.
6659
6660 Example :
6661 option ldap-check
6662
6663 See also : "option httpchk"
6664
6665
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006666option external-check
6667 Use external processes for server health checks
6668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6669 yes | no | yes | yes
6670
6671 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6672 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6673 command".
6674
6675 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6676
6677 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6678
6679
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006680option log-health-checks
6681no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006682 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6684 yes | no | yes | yes
6685 Arguments : none
6686
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006687 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6688 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6689 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006690
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006691 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6692 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6693 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6694 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6695 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6696
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006697 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006698 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006699
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006700 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6701 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6702 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006703
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006704
6705option log-separate-errors
6706no option log-separate-errors
6707 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6709 yes | yes | yes | no
6710 Arguments : none
6711
6712 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6713 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6714 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6715 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6716 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6717 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6718 provides very important information.
6719
6720 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6721 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6722 error logs.
6723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006724 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006725 logging.
6726
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006727
6728option logasap
6729no option logasap
6730 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6732 yes | yes | yes | no
6733 Arguments : none
6734
6735 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6736 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6737 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6738 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6739 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6740 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6741 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006742 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006743 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6744 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6745
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006746 Examples :
6747 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6748 mode http
6749 option httplog
6750 option logasap
6751 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6752
6753 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6754 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6755 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6756 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6757
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006758 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006759 logging.
6760
6761
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006762option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006763 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6765 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006766 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006767 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6768 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006769 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006770
6771 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6772 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006773 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006774 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6775 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6776 in the MySQL table, like this :
6777
6778 USE mysql;
6779 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6780 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6781
6782 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006783 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006784 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6785 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6786 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6787 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6788 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6789 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6790 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6791
6792 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6793 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006794
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006795 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006796
6797 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6798 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6799 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6800 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006801 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6802 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006803
6804 See also: "option httpchk"
6805
6806
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006807option nolinger
6808no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006809 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006810 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6811 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006812 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006813
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006814 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006815 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6816 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6817 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6818 connections.
6819
6820 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6821 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6822 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6823 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6824 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6825 this too.
6826
6827 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6828 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6829 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6830
6831 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6832 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6833 for servers.
6834
6835 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6836 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6837
6838
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006839option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6840 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6842 yes | yes | yes | yes
6843 Arguments :
6844 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6845 matching <network>
6846 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6847 header name.
6848
6849 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6850 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6851 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6852 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6853 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6854 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6855 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6856 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6857 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6858 possible that the client has already brought one.
6859
6860 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6861 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6862 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6863 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6864 header and requires different one.
6865
6866 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6867 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6868 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6869 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6870 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6871 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6872 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6873
6874 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6875 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6876 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6877 both are defined.
6878
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006879 Examples :
6880 # Original Destination address
6881 frontend www
6882 mode http
6883 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6884
6885 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6886 backend www
6887 mode http
6888 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6889
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006890 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006891
6892
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006893option persist
6894no option persist
6895 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6896 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6897 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006898 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006899
6900 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6901 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6902 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6903 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6904 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6905 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6906 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6907 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6908 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6909 redirected to another valid server.
6910
6911 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6912 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6913
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006914 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006915
6916
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006917option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6918 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6920 yes | no | yes | yes
6921 Arguments :
6922 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6923 PostgreSQL server.
6924
6925 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6926 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6927 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6928 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6929
6930 See also: "option httpchk"
6931
6932
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006933option prefer-last-server
6934no option prefer-last-server
6935 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6936 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6937 yes | no | yes | yes
6938 Arguments : none
6939
6940 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6941 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6942 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6943 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6944 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6945 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6946 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6947 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6948 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006949 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6950 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006951 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6952 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6953 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006954 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6955 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6956 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006957
6958 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6959 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6960
6961 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6962
6963
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006964option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006965option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006966no option redispatch
6967 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6968 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6969 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006970 Arguments :
6971 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6972 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6973 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006974 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006975 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006976 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006977 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6978 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6979 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6980
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006981
6982 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6983 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6984 be able to access the service anymore.
6985
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01006986 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
6987 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006988
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006989 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006990 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6991 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006992
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006993 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6994 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6995
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006996 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006997
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006998
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006999option redis-check
7000 Use redis health checks for server testing
7001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7002 yes | no | yes | yes
7003 Arguments : none
7004
7005 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7006 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7007 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7008 find the "+PONG" response message.
7009
7010 Example :
7011 option redis-check
7012
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007013 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007014
7015
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007016option smtpchk
7017option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7018 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7020 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007021 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007022 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007023 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007024 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7025
7026 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7027 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7028 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7029
7030 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7031 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7032 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7033 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7034 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7035 dead server.
7036
7037 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7038 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007039 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007040 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7041
7042 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7043 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7044 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7045 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007046 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007047
7048 Example :
7049 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7050
7051 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7052
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007053
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007054option socket-stats
7055no option socket-stats
7056
7057 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7059 yes | yes | yes | no
7060
7061 Arguments : none
7062
7063
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007064option splice-auto
7065no option splice-auto
7066 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7068 yes | yes | yes | yes
7069 Arguments : none
7070
7071 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7072 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007073 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007074 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007075 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007076 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7077 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7078 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7079 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7080
7081 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7082 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7083 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7084 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7085 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7086 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7087 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7088 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7089 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7090 keyword.
7091
7092 Example :
7093 option splice-auto
7094
7095 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7096 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7097
7098 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7099 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7100
7101
7102option splice-request
7103no option splice-request
7104 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7106 yes | yes | yes | yes
7107 Arguments : none
7108
7109 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007110 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007111 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7112 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7113 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7114 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7115
7116 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7117
7118 Example :
7119 option splice-request
7120
7121 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7122 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7123
7124 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7125 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7126
7127
7128option splice-response
7129no option splice-response
7130 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7132 yes | yes | yes | yes
7133 Arguments : none
7134
7135 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007136 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007137 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7138 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7139 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7140 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7141
7142 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7143
7144 Example :
7145 option splice-response
7146
7147 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7148 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7149
7150 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7151 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7152
7153
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007154option spop-check
7155 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7157 no | no | no | yes
7158 Arguments : none
7159
7160 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7161 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7162 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7163 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7164
7165 Example :
7166 option spop-check
7167
7168 See also : "option httpchk"
7169
7170
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007171option srvtcpka
7172no option srvtcpka
7173 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7175 yes | no | yes | yes
7176 Arguments : none
7177
7178 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7179 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007180 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007181 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7182
7183 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7184 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7185 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7186 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7187
7188 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7189 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7190 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7191 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7192 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7193
7194 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7195
7196 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7197 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7198 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7199
7200 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7201 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7202
7203 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7204
7205
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007206option ssl-hello-chk
7207 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7209 yes | no | yes | yes
7210 Arguments : none
7211
7212 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7213 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7214 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7215 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7216 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7217 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7218 hello message.
7219
7220 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7221 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7222 messages, which is appreciable.
7223
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007224 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7225 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7226 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007227
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007228 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7229
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007230
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007231option tcp-check
7232 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7233 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7234 yes | no | yes | yes
7235
7236 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7237 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7238
7239 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7240 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7241 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7242
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007243 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007244 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7245 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7246 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7247 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7248 only.
7249
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007250 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007251 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7252 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7253 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7254 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7255
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007256 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007257 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7258 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007259 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007260 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7261 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7262 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7263 the respective protocols.
7264 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007265 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007266
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007267 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7268 script.
7269
7270 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7271 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7272 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7273 The "comment" is of course optional.
7274
7275
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007276 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007277 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007278 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007279 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007280
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007281 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007282 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007283 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007284
7285 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7286 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007287 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007288 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007289 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007290 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007291 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007292 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007293 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7294 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007295 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007296 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7297 tcp-check expect string +OK
7298
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007299 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007300 (send many headers before analyzing)
7301 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007302 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007303 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7304 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7305 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7306 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007307 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007308
7309
7310 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7311
7312
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007313option tcp-smart-accept
7314no option tcp-smart-accept
7315 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7317 yes | yes | yes | no
7318 Arguments : none
7319
7320 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7321 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7322 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7323 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7324 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7325 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7326
7327 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7328 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7329 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7330 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7331
7332 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7333 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7334 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007335 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007336
7337 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7338 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7339 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7340
7341 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7342 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7343 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7344
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007345 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7346
7347
7348option tcp-smart-connect
7349no option tcp-smart-connect
7350 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7352 yes | no | yes | yes
7353 Arguments : none
7354
7355 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7356 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7357 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7358 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7359 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7360
7361 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7362 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7363 complex.
7364
7365 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7366 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7367 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7368
7369 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7370 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7371
7372 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7373
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007374
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007375option tcpka
7376 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7378 yes | yes | yes | yes
7379 Arguments : none
7380
7381 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7382 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007383 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007384 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7385
7386 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7387 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7388 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7389 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7390
7391 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7392 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7393 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7394 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7395 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7396
7397 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7398
7399 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7400 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7401 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7402 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7403 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7404 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7405 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7406 backends.
7407
7408 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7409
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007410
7411option tcplog
7412 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007414 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007415 Arguments : none
7416
7417 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7418 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7419 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7420 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7421 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7422 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7423 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7424 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7425
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007426 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7427
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007428 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007429
7430
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007431option transparent
7432no option transparent
7433 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007435 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007436 Arguments : none
7437
7438 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7439 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7440 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7441 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7442 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7443 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7444 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7445 appropriate server.
7446
7447 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7448 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7449
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007450 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007451 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007452
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007453
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007454external-check command <command>
7455 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7457 yes | no | yes | yes
7458
7459 Arguments :
7460 <command> is the external command to run
7461
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007462 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7463
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007464 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007465
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007466 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7467 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7468 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7469 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7470 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7471 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007472
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007473 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7474
7475 Environment variables :
7476 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7477 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7478
7479 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7480
7481 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7482
7483 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7484 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7485 for a UNIX socket).
7486
7487 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7488
7489 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7490
7491 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7492
7493 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7494
7495 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7496
7497 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7498 socket).
7499
7500 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7501 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7502
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007503 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7504
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007505 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7506 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7507 failed.
7508
7509 Example :
7510 external-check command /bin/true
7511
7512 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7513
7514
7515external-check path <path>
7516 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7518 yes | no | yes | yes
7519
7520 Arguments :
7521 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7522
7523 The default path is "".
7524
7525 Example :
7526 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7527
7528 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7529 "external-check command"
7530
7531
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007532persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007533persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007534 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7536 yes | no | yes | yes
7537 Arguments :
7538 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007539 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7540 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007541
7542 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7543 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007544 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007545 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7546 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7547 forwarded to this server.
7548
7549 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7550 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7551 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007552 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007553 a single "listen" section.
7554
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007555 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7556 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7557 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7558
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007559 Example :
7560 listen tse-farm
7561 bind :3389
7562 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7563 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7564 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7565 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7566 persist rdp-cookie
7567 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007568 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007569 balance rdp-cookie
7570 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7571 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7572
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007573 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7574 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007575
7576
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007577rate-limit sessions <rate>
7578 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7580 yes | yes | yes | no
7581 Arguments :
7582 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7583 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7584
7585 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7586 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7587 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7588 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7589 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7590 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7591
7592 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7593 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7594 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7595 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7596
7597 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7598 listen smtp
7599 mode tcp
7600 bind :25
7601 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007602 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007603
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007604 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7605 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7606 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007607
7608 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7609
7610
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007611redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7612redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7613redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007614 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7616 no | yes | yes | yes
7617
7618 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007619 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007620
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007621 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007622 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007623 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7624 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7625 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007626
7627 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7628 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7629 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7630 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7631 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007632 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7633 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7634 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7635 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007636
7637 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7638 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7639 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7640 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7641 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7642 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007643 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007644 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007645 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7646 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7647 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007648
7649 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007650 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7651 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7652 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007653 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007654 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7655 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7656 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7657 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007658
7659 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007660 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007661
7662 - "drop-query"
7663 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7664 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7665 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7666 with a location-type redirect.
7667
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007668 - "append-slash"
7669 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7670 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7671 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7672 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7673
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007674 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7675 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7676 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7677 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7678 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7679 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7680 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7681
7682 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7683 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7684 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7685 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7686 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7687 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7688 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007689
7690 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7691 acl clear dst_port 80
7692 acl secure dst_port 8080
7693 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007694 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007695 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007696 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7697
7698 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007699 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7700 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7701 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007702 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007703
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007704 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7705 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7706 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7707
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007708 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007709 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007710
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007711 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007712 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7713 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7714 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007715
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007716 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007717
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007718
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007719retries <value>
7720 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7721 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7722 yes | no | yes | yes
7723 Arguments :
7724 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7725 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7726 default value is 3.
7727
7728 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7729 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7730 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7731
7732 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007733 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7734 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007735
7736 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7737 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7738
7739 See also : "option redispatch"
7740
7741
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007742retry-on [list of keywords]
7743 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
7744 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7745 yes | no | yes | yes
7746 Arguments :
7747 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
7748 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
7749 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
7750 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
7751
7752 none never retry
7753
7754 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
7755 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
7756
7757 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
7758 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
7759 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
7760 request timeout on the server side, poor network
7761 condition, or a server crash or restart while
7762 processing the request.
7763
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02007764 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
7765 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
7766 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
7767 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
7768 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
7769 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
7770 overflow attack for example).
7771
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007772 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
7773 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
7774 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
7775 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
7776 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
7777 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
7778 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
7779 amplify denial of service attacks.
7780
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02007781 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
7782 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
7783 considered to be safe to retry.
7784
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007785 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
7786 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
7787 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
7788 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
7789
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02007790 all-retryable-errors
7791 retry request for any error that are considered
7792 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
7793 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
7794 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
7795
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007796 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
7797 not cumulative.
7798
7799 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
7800 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
7801 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
7802 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
7803
7804 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
7805 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
7806 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
7807 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
7808 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
7809 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
7810 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
7811 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
7812 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
7813 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
7814 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
7815 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
7816
7817 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
7818 should not use this directive.
7819
7820 The default is "conn-failure".
7821
7822 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
7823
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007824server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007825 Declare a server in a backend
7826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7827 no | no | yes | yes
7828 Arguments :
7829 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007830 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007831 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007832
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007833 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7834 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7835 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7836 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007837 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7838 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7839 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7840 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7841 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007842 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7843 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7844 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7845 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7846 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7847 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7848 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007849 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02007850 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
7851 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
7852 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
7853 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
7854 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
7855 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007856 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7857 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007858 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7859 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007860
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007861 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007862 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7863 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7864 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7865 adding this value to the client's port.
7866
7867 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7868 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007869 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007870
7871 Examples :
7872 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7873 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007874 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007875 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7876 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7877 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007878
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007879 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7880 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7881 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7882 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7883 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7884
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007885 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7886 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007887
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007888server-state-file-name [<file>]
7889 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7890 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7891 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7892 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7893 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7894 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7895
7896 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7897 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7898
7899 global
7900 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7901
7902 backend bk
7903 load-server-state-from-file
7904
7905 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7906 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007907
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007908server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7909 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7910 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7912 no | no | yes | yes
7913
7914 Arguments:
7915 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7916
7917 <num | range>
7918 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7919 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7920 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7921 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7922
7923 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7924
7925 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7926
7927 <params*>
7928 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7929 keyword.
7930
7931 Examples:
7932 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7933 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7934 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7935
7936 # or
7937 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7938
7939 # would be equivalent to:
7940 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7941 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7942 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7943
7944
7945
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007946source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007947source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007948source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007949 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7951 yes | no | yes | yes
7952 Arguments :
7953 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7954 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007955
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007956 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007957 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7958 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7959 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7960 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7961 supported prefixes are :
7962 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7963 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7964 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007965 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007966 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7967 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007968
7969 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7970 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007971 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7972 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7973 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007974
7975 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7976 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7977 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7978 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7979 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7980 <addr>.
7981
7982 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7983 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7984 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7985 port.
7986
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007987 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7988 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7989 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7990 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007991 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007992 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7993 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7994 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7995 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7996 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7997 HTTP header.
7998
7999 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8000 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008001 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008002 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8003 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8004 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8005 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8006 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8007 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8008 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8009
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008010 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8011 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8012 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8013 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8014 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8015 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8016
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008017 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8018 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8019 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8020 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8021
8022 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8023 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8024 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8025 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8026 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8027 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8028
8029 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8030 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8031 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8032 there are two methods :
8033
8034 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8035 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8036 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8037 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8038 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8039 of the client ranges may be used.
8040
8041 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8042 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8043 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8044 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8045 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8046 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8047 same session.
8048
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008049 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8050 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8051 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008052 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008053
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008054 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8055
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008056 Examples :
8057 backend private
8058 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8059 source 192.168.1.200
8060
8061 backend transparent_ssl1
8062 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8063 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8064
8065 backend transparent_ssl2
8066 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8067 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8068 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8069
8070 backend transparent_ssl3
8071 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8072 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8073 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8074
8075 backend transparent_smtp
8076 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8077 # with Tproxy version 4.
8078 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8079
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008080 backend transparent_http
8081 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8082 # proxy.
8083 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8084
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008085 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008086 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8087
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008088
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008089stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8090 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008092 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008093
8094 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8095 matched.
8096
8097 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8098 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8099
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008100 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8101 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008102 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008103
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008104 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8105 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8106 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8107 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008108
8109 Example :
8110 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8111 backend stats_localhost
8112 stats enable
8113 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8114
8115 Example :
8116 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8117 backend stats_auth
8118 stats enable
8119 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8120 stats admin if TRUE
8121
8122 Example :
8123 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8124 userlist stats-auth
8125 group admin users admin
8126 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8127 group readonly users haproxy
8128 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8129
8130 backend stats_auth
8131 stats enable
8132 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8133 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8134 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8135 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8136
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008137 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8138 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8139 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008140
8141
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008142stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8143 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008145 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008146 Arguments :
8147 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8148
8149 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8150
8151 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8152 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8153 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8154 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8155 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8156 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8157
8158 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8159 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8160 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008161 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008162
8163 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8164 report using "stats scope".
8165
8166 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8167 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8168 unobvious parameters.
8169
8170 Example :
8171 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8172 backend public_www
8173 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8174 stats enable
8175 stats hide-version
8176 stats scope .
8177 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008178 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008179 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8180 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8181
8182 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8183 backend private_monitoring
8184 stats enable
8185 stats uri /admin?stats
8186 stats refresh 5s
8187
8188 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8189
8190
8191stats enable
8192 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008194 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008195 Arguments : none
8196
8197 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8198 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8199 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8200 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8201 - stats auth : no authentication
8202 - stats scope : no restriction
8203
8204 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8205 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8206 unobvious parameters.
8207
8208 Example :
8209 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8210 backend public_www
8211 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8212 stats enable
8213 stats hide-version
8214 stats scope .
8215 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008216 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008217 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8218 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8219
8220 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8221 backend private_monitoring
8222 stats enable
8223 stats uri /admin?stats
8224 stats refresh 5s
8225
8226 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8227
8228
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008229stats hide-version
8230 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008232 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008233 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008234
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008235 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8236 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8237 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8238 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8239 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8240 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008241
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008242 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8243 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8244 unobvious parameters.
8245
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008246 Example :
8247 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8248 backend public_www
8249 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008250 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008251 stats hide-version
8252 stats scope .
8253 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008254 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008255 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8256 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008257
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008258 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8259 backend private_monitoring
8260 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008261 stats uri /admin?stats
8262 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008263
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008264 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008265
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008266
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008267stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8268 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8269 Access control for statistics
8270
8271 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8272 no | no | yes | yes
8273
8274 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8275 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8276 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8277 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8278 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8279 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8280
8281 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8282 instance.
8283
8284 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8285 about ACL usage.
8286
8287
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008288stats realm <realm>
8289 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008291 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008292 Arguments :
8293 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8294 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8295 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8296
8297 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8298 using a backslash ('\').
8299
8300 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8301 only related to authentication.
8302
8303 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8304 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8305 unobvious parameters.
8306
8307 Example :
8308 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8309 backend public_www
8310 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8311 stats enable
8312 stats hide-version
8313 stats scope .
8314 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008315 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008316 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8317 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8318
8319 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8320 backend private_monitoring
8321 stats enable
8322 stats uri /admin?stats
8323 stats refresh 5s
8324
8325 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8326
8327
8328stats refresh <delay>
8329 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008331 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008332 Arguments :
8333 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8334 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8335 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8336 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8337 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8338 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8339
8340 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8341 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8342 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8343 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8344
8345 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8346 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8347 unobvious parameters.
8348
8349 Example :
8350 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8351 backend public_www
8352 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8353 stats enable
8354 stats hide-version
8355 stats scope .
8356 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008357 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008358 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8359 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8360
8361 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8362 backend private_monitoring
8363 stats enable
8364 stats uri /admin?stats
8365 stats refresh 5s
8366
8367 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8368
8369
8370stats scope { <name> | "." }
8371 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008373 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008374 Arguments :
8375 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8376 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8377 section in which the statement appears.
8378
8379 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8380 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8381 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8382 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8383 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8384 exists.
8385
8386 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8387 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8388 unobvious parameters.
8389
8390 Example :
8391 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8392 backend public_www
8393 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8394 stats enable
8395 stats hide-version
8396 stats scope .
8397 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008398 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008399 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8400 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8401
8402 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8403 backend private_monitoring
8404 stats enable
8405 stats uri /admin?stats
8406 stats refresh 5s
8407
8408 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8409
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008410
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008411stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008412 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008414 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008415
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008416 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008417 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8418
8419 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8420 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8421
8422 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8423 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008424 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008425
8426 Example :
8427 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8428 backend private_monitoring
8429 stats enable
8430 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8431 stats uri /admin?stats
8432 stats refresh 5s
8433
8434 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8435 global section.
8436
8437
8438stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008439 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8441 yes | yes | yes | yes
8442 Arguments : none
8443
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008444 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008445 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8446 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8447 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8448 - IP (socket, server)
8449 - cookie (backend, server)
8450
8451 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8452 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008453 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008454
8455 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8456
8457
8458stats show-node [ <name> ]
8459 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008461 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008462 Arguments:
8463 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8464 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8465
8466 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8467 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008468 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008469
8470 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8471 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8472 unobvious parameters.
8473
8474 Example:
8475 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8476 backend private_monitoring
8477 stats enable
8478 stats show-node Europe-1
8479 stats uri /admin?stats
8480 stats refresh 5s
8481
8482 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8483 section.
8484
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008485
8486stats uri <prefix>
8487 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008489 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008490 Arguments :
8491 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8492 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8493 query string.
8494
8495 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8496 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8497 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8498 possible to reach it in the application.
8499
8500 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008501 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008502 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8503 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8504 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8505 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8506
8507 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8508 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8509 an address or a port to statistics only.
8510
8511 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8512 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8513 unobvious parameters.
8514
8515 Example :
8516 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8517 backend public_www
8518 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8519 stats enable
8520 stats hide-version
8521 stats scope .
8522 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008523 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008524 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8525 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8526
8527 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8528 backend private_monitoring
8529 stats enable
8530 stats uri /admin?stats
8531 stats refresh 5s
8532
8533 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8534
8535
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008536stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8537 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008539 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008540
8541 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008542 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008543 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008544 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008545 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8546
8547 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8548 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8549 the "stick-table" statement.
8550
8551 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8552 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8553 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8554 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8555 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8556
8557 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8558 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8559 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8560 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8561 transformation rules.
8562
8563 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8564 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8565 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8566 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8567 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8568 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8569 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8570
8571 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8572 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8573 ACL based conditions.
8574
8575 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8576 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8577 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8578 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8579
8580 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8581 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8582 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8583 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8584
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008585 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8586 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008587 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008588
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008589 Example :
8590 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8591 # last 30 minutes
8592 backend pop
8593 mode tcp
8594 balance roundrobin
8595 stick store-request src
8596 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8597 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8598 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8599
8600 backend smtp
8601 mode tcp
8602 balance roundrobin
8603 stick match src table pop
8604 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8605 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8606
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008607 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008608 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008609
8610
8611stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8612 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8614 no | no | yes | yes
8615
8616 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8617 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8618 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8619 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8620
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008621 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8622 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008623 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008624
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008625 Examples :
8626 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008627 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008628
8629 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8630 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8631 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8632
8633
8634 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8635 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8636 backend http
8637 mode http
8638 balance roundrobin
8639 stick on src table https
8640 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8641 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8642 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8643
8644 backend https
8645 mode tcp
8646 balance roundrobin
8647 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8648 stick on src
8649 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8650 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8651
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008652 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008653
8654
8655stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8656 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8658 no | no | yes | yes
8659
8660 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008661 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008662 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008663 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008664 server is selected.
8665
8666 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8667 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8668 the "stick-table" statement.
8669
8670 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8671 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8672 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8673 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8674 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8675 address.
8676
8677 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8678 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8679 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8680 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8681 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8682 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8683 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8684 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8685 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8686 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8687
8688 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8689 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8690 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8691 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8692 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8693 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8694 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8695
8696 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8697 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8698 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8699 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8700
8701 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8702 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8703 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8704 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8705 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8706 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008707 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8708 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8709 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8710 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8711 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8712 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008713
8714 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8715 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8716 the request.
8717
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008718 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8719 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008720 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008721
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008722 Example :
8723 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8724 # last 30 minutes
8725 backend pop
8726 mode tcp
8727 balance roundrobin
8728 stick store-request src
8729 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8730 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8731 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8732
8733 backend smtp
8734 mode tcp
8735 balance roundrobin
8736 stick match src table pop
8737 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8738 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8739
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008740 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008741 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008742
8743
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008744stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008745 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8746 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008747 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008749 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008750
8751 Arguments :
8752 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8753 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8754 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8755 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8756
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008757 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8758 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8759 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8760 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8761
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008762 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8763 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8764 instance.
8765
8766 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8767 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8768 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8769 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8770 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8771 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008772 to 32 characters.
8773
8774 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8775 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8776 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008777 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008778 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8779 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008780
8781 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008782 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8783 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008784 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8785 increase.
8786
8787 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008788 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8789 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8790 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008791
8792 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8793 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8794 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8795 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008796 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008797 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8798 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8799 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8800 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8801 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8802 parameter (see below).
8803
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008804 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8805 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8806 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8807 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8808 soft restart.
8809
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008810 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8811 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008812
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008813 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8814 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8815 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8816 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008817 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008818 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008819 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8820 if not expiration delay is specified.
8821
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008822 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8823 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8824 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8825 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008826 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8827 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8828 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8829 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8830 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8831 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8832 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8833 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8834 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8835 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8836 types and their arguments.
8837
8838 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8839 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8840 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8841 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8842
8843 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8844 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8845 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008846 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008847
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008848 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8849 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8850 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008851 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008852 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008853 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008854
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008855 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8856 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8857 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8858 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
8859
8860 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
8861 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8862 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8863 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8864 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8865 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
8866
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008867 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8868 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8869 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8870 they were received.
8871
8872 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8873 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8874 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8875 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8876 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8877
8878 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8879 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8880 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8881 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8882 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8883
8884 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8885 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8886 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8887
8888 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8889 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8890 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8891 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8892 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8893
8894 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8895 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8896 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8897 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8898 the client side.
8899
8900 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8901 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8902 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8903 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8904 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8905 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8906 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8907
8908 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8909 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8910 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8911 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8912 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8913 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008914 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008915
8916 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8917 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8918 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8919 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8920 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8921 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8922
8923 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008924 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008925 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8926 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8927
8928 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8929 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8930 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8931 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8932 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8933 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8934 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8935 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8936 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8937 recommended for better fairness.
8938
8939 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008940 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008941 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8942 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8943
8944 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8945 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8946 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8947 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8948 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8949 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8950 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8951 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8952 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8953 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008954
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008955 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8956 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008957 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8958 reference it.
8959
8960 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8961 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008962 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8963 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8964 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008965
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008966 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8967 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8968 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8969 something that can be ignored.
8970
8971 Example:
8972 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8973 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8974 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8975 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8976
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008977 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008978 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008979
8980
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008981stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008982 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8984 no | no | yes | yes
8985
8986 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008987 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008988 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008989 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008990 server is selected.
8991
8992 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8993 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8994 the "stick-table" statement.
8995
8996 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8997 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8998 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8999 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9000
9001 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9002 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9003 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9004 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9005 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9006 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009007 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009008 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9009 rules.
9010
9011 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9012 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9013 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9014 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9015 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9016 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9017 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9018
9019 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9020 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9021 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9022 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9023
9024 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9025 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9026 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9027 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9028 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9029 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009030 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9031 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9032 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9033 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9034 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9035 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9036 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9037 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9038 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009039
9040 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9041
9042 Example :
9043 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9044 backend https
9045 mode tcp
9046 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009047 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009048 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009049
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009050 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9051 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9052
9053 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9054 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9055 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9056
9057 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9058 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009059
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009060 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9061 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9062 # at offset 44.
9063
9064 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9065 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9066
9067 # Learn on response if server hello.
9068 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009069
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009070 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9071 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9072
9073 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9074 extraction.
9075
9076
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009077tcp-check connect [params*]
9078 Opens a new connection
9079 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9080 no | no | yes | yes
9081
9082 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9083 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9084 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9085
9086 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9087 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9088 of the sequence.
9089
9090 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9091 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9092 do.
9093
9094 Parameters :
9095 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9096 use the TCP connection.
9097
9098 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9099 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9100 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9101
9102 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9103
9104 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9105
9106 Examples:
9107 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9108 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9109 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9110 option tcp-check
9111 tcp-check connect
9112 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9113 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9114 tcp-check send \r\n
9115 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9116 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9117 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9118 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9119 tcp-check send \r\n
9120 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9121 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9122
9123 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9124 option tcp-check
9125 tcp-check connect port 110
9126 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9127 tcp-check connect port 143
9128 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9129 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9130
9131 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9132
9133
9134tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009135 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009136 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9137 no | no | yes | yes
9138
9139 Arguments :
9140 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9141 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9142 binary.
9143 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9144 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9145 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9146
9147 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9148 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9149 with the usual backslash ('\').
9150 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009151 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009152 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9153 used upper or lower case.
9154
9155
9156 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9157
9158 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9159 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9160 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9161 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9162 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9163 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9164 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9165 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9166
9167 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9168 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9169 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9170 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9171 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9172 expression.
9173
9174 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9175 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9176 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9177 this exact hexadecimal string.
9178 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9179
9180 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9181 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9182 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9183 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9184 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9185 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9186 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9187 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9188 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9189 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9190 the null character.
9191
9192 Examples :
9193 # perform a POP check
9194 option tcp-check
9195 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9196
9197 # perform an IMAP check
9198 option tcp-check
9199 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9200
9201 # look for the redis master server
9202 option tcp-check
9203 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009204 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009205 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9206 tcp-check expect string role:master
9207 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9208 tcp-check expect string +OK
9209
9210
9211 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9212 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9213
9214
9215tcp-check send <data>
9216 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9217 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9218 no | no | yes | yes
9219
9220 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9221 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9222
9223 Examples :
9224 # look for the redis master server
9225 option tcp-check
9226 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9227 tcp-check expect string role:master
9228
9229 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9230 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9231
9232
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009233tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9234 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009235 tcp health check
9236 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9237 no | no | yes | yes
9238
9239 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9240 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009241 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009242 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9243 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9244 hexadecimal string.
9245 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9246
9247 Examples :
9248 # redis check in binary
9249 option tcp-check
9250 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9251 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9252
9253
9254 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9255 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9256
9257
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009258tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9259 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9261 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009262 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009263 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9264 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009265
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009266 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009267
9268 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9269 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009270 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9271 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9272 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9273 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9274 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9275 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009276
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009277 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9278 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9279 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9280 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009281
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009282 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009283 - accept :
9284 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9285 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9286 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009287
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009288 - reject :
9289 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9290 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9291 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9292 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9293 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9294 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9295 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9296 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9297 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9298 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9299 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009300 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009301
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009302 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9303 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9304 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9305 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9306 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9307 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9308 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9309 hosts.
9310
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009311 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9312 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9313 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9314 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9315 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9316 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9317 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9318 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9319
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009320 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9321 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9322 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9323 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9324 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9325 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9326 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9327 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9328 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009329 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9330 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009331
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009332 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009333 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009334 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9335 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9336 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009337 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009338 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9339 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9340 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9341 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9342 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9343 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9344 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9345 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009346
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009347 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009348 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009349 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009350 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009351 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9352 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9353 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009354
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009355 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9356 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9357 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9358 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009359
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009360 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9361 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9362 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9363 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9364 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009365 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9366 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9367 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9368 layer7 information is extracted.
9369
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009370 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9371 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9372 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9373 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9374 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009375
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009376 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9377 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9378 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9379 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9380
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009381 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9382 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9383 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9384 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9385
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009386 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9387 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9388 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9389 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9390 continues.
9391
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009392 - set-src <expr> :
9393 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9394 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9395 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009396 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009397
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009398 Arguments:
9399 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9400 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009401
9402 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009403 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9404
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009405 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9406 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009407
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009408 - set-src-port <expr> :
9409 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9410 expression.
9411
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009412 Arguments:
9413 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9414 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009415
9416 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009417 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9418
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009419 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9420 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9421 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009422
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009423 - set-dst <expr> :
9424 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9425 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9426 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9427 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9428 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9429
9430 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9431 followed by some converters.
9432
9433 Example:
9434
9435 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9436 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9437
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009438 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9439 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9440
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009441 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9442 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9443 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9444 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9445
9446
9447 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9448 followed by some converters.
9449
9450 Example:
9451
9452 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9453
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009454 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9455 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9456 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9457
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009458 - "silent-drop" :
9459 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009460 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009461 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9462 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9463 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9464 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9465 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009466 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9467 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009468 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9469 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009470 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009471 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9472 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9473 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9474 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9475
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009476 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9477 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9478 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009479
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009480 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9481 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9482 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009483
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009484 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009485 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009486 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009487
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009488 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9489 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9490 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009491
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009492 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009493 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9494 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009495
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009496 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9497
9498 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9499
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009500 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9501
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009502 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009503
9504
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009505tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9506 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009508 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009509 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009510 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9511 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009512
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009513 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009514
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009515 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009516 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9517 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9518 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9519 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009520
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009521 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9522 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9523 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9524 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009525 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9526 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9527 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9528 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9529 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9530 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009531 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009532 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009533
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009534 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9535 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9536 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9537 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009538
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009539 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009540 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009541 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009542 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9543 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009544 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009545 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009546 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009547 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009548 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009549 - set-dst <expr>
9550 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009551 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009552 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009553 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009554 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009555
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009556 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9557 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009558 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
9559 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009560
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009561 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9562 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9563 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9564 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9565 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9566 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009567
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009568 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009569 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9570 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009571
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009572 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009573 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9574 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9575 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9576 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009577 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9578 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9579 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009580
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009581 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009582 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9583 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9584 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009585
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009586 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
9587 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
9588
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009589 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009590 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9591 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009592
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009593 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9594 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009595 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009596 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9597 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009598 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009599 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009600 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009601 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9602 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009603 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009604 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9605 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009606
9607 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9608 followed by some converters.
9609
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009610 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9611 <var-name>.
9612
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009613 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9614 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9615 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9616 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9617 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9618
9619 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9620 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9621 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9622 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9623 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9624 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9625 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9626 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9627 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9628 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9629 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9630
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009631 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9632 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9633 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9634 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9635 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9636
9637 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9638
9639 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9640
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009641 Example:
9642
9643 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009644 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009645
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009646 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009647 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9648 # and reject everything else.
9649 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9650 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009651 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009652 tcp-request content reject
9653
9654 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009655 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9656 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9657 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009658 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009659
9660 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9661 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9662 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009663 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009664 tcp-request content reject
9665
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009666 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009667 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009668 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009669 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009670 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9671 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009672
9673 Example:
9674 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9675 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009676 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009677
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009678 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009679 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009680
9681 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009682 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009683 # protecting all our sites
9684 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009685 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9686 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009687 ...
9688 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9689
9690 backend http_dynamic
9691 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009692 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009693 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009694 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009695 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009696 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009697 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009698
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009699 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009700
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009701 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9702 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009703
9704
9705tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9706 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009708 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009709 Arguments :
9710 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9711 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9712 as explained at the top of this document.
9713
9714 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9715 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9716 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9717 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9718 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9719
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009720 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9721 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9722 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9723 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9724
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009725 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9726 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009727 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009728 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009729 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9730 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9731 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9732 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009733
9734 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9735 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9736 it pass through unaffected.
9737
9738 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9739 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9740 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009741 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009742 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9743 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009744 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9745 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9746 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009747
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009748 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009749 "timeout client".
9750
9751
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009752tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9753 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9755 no | no | yes | yes
9756 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009757 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9758 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009759
9760 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9761
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009762 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009763 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9764 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009765 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9766 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009767
9768 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9769
9770 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9771 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9772 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9773 inserted.
9774
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009775 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009776 - accept :
9777 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9778 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9779 the rules evaluation.
9780
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009781 - close :
9782 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9783 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9784 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9785 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9786 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9787 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009788 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009789 protocols.
9790
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009791 - reject :
9792 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9793 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009794 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009795
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009796 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9797 Sets a variable.
9798
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009799 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9800 Unsets a variable.
9801
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009802 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9803 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9804 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9805 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9806
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009807 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9808 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9809 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9810 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9811
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009812 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9813 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9814 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9815 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9816 continues.
9817
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009818 - "silent-drop" :
9819 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009820 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009821 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9822 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9823 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9824 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9825 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009826 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9827 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009828 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9829 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009830 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009831 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9832 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9833 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9834 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9835
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009836 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9837 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9838
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009839 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9840 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9841 for changing the default action to a reject.
9842
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009843 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9844 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9845 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9846 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009847 period.
9848
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009849 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9850 declared inline.
9851
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009852 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9853 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009854 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009855 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9856 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009857 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009858 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009859 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009860 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9861 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009862 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009863 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9864 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009865
9866 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9867 followed by some converters.
9868
9869 Example:
9870
9871 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9872
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009873 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9874 <var-name>.
9875
9876 Example:
9877
9878 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9879
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009880 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9881 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9882 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9883 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9884 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9885
9886 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9887
9888 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9889
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009890 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9891
9892 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9893
9894
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009895tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9896 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9898 no | yes | yes | no
9899 Arguments :
9900 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9901 below.
9902
9903 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9904
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009905 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009906 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9907 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9908 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9909 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9910 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9911 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9912 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009913 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009914 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9915 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9916 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9917 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9918 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9919 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9920 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9921 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9922 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9923 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9924 instead.
9925
9926 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9927 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9928 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9929 rules which may be inserted.
9930
9931 Several types of actions are supported :
9932 - accept : the request is accepted
9933 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9934 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9935 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009936 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009937 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9938 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009939 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009940 - silent-drop
9941
9942 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9943 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9944 sections for a complete description.
9945
9946 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9947 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9948 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9949
9950 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9951 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9952 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9953 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9954 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9955
9956 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9957 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9958
9959 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9960 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9961 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9962
9963 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9964 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9965 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9966
9967 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9968 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9969 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9970
9971 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9972 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9973 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9974
9975 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9976
9977 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9978
9979
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009980tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9981 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9983 no | no | yes | yes
9984 Arguments :
9985 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9986 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9987 as explained at the top of this document.
9988
9989 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9990
9991
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009992timeout check <timeout>
9993 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9994 established.
9995
9996 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9997 yes | no | yes | yes
9998 Arguments:
9999 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10000 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10001 as explained at the top of this document.
10002
10003 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10004 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010005 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010006 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010007 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10008 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10009 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010010
10011 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10012 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10013
10014 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10015 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010016 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010017
10018 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10019 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10020 forget about it.
10021
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010022 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10023 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010024
10025
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010026timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010027 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10029 yes | yes | yes | no
10030 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010031 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010032 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10033 as explained at the top of this document.
10034
10035 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10036 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10037 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010038 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10039 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10040 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10041 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010042 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10043 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10044 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010045 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010046 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010047 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10048 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010049 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10050 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010051
10052 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10053 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10054 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10055 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010056 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010057 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10058
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010059 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010060
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010061 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010062
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010063
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010064timeout client-fin <timeout>
10065 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10067 yes | yes | yes | no
10068 Arguments :
10069 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10070 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10071 as explained at the top of this document.
10072
10073 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10074 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10075 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10076 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10077 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10078 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10079 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010080 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10081 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10082 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010083
10084 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10085 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10086 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10087
10088 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10089
10090
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010091timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010092 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10094 yes | no | yes | yes
10095 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010096 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010097 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10098 as explained at the top of this document.
10099
10100 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010101 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010102 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010103 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010104 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10105 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010106
10107 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10108 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10109 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10110 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010111 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010112 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10113
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010114 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010115
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010116
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010117timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10118 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10120 yes | yes | yes | yes
10121 Arguments :
10122 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10123 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10124 as explained at the top of this document.
10125
10126 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10127 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10128 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10129 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10130 once the request has started to present itself.
10131
10132 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10133 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10134 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10135 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10136 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10137
10138 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10139 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10140 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10141 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10142
10143 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10144 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010145 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010146 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10147 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010148 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010149
10150 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10151 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10152 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10153 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10154
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010155 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10156 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010157 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10158
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010159 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10160
10161
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010162timeout http-request <timeout>
10163 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010165 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010166 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010167 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010168 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10169 as explained at the top of this document.
10170
10171 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10172 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10173 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10174 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10175 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10176 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10177 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010178 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10179 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10180 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10181 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010182 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010183 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10184 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010185
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010186 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10187 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10188 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10189 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10190 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010191 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010192
10193 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10194 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010195 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010196 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10197 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10198
10199 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010200 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10201 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10202 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010203
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010204 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010205 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010206
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010207
10208timeout queue <timeout>
10209 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10211 yes | no | yes | yes
10212 Arguments :
10213 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10214 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10215 as explained at the top of this document.
10216
10217 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10218 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10219 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10220 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10221 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10222
10223 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10224 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10225 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10226 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10227
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010228 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010229
10230
10231timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010232 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10234 yes | no | yes | yes
10235 Arguments :
10236 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10237 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10238 as explained at the top of this document.
10239
10240 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10241 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10242 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10243 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10244 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10245 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10246 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10247
10248 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10249 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10250 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10251 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10252 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010253 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010254 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010255 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10256 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010257 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10258 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010259
10260 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10261 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10262 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10263 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010264 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010265 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10266
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010267 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010268
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010269
10270timeout server-fin <timeout>
10271 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10273 yes | no | yes | yes
10274 Arguments :
10275 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10276 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10277 as explained at the top of this document.
10278
10279 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10280 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10281 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10282 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10283 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10284 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10285 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10286 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10287 situations, it should not be needed.
10288
10289 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10290 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10291 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10292
10293 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10294
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010295
10296timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010297 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10299 yes | yes | yes | yes
10300 Arguments :
10301 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10302 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10303 as explained at the top of this document.
10304
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010305 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
10306 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
10307 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010308
10309 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10310 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10311 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10312 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010313 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010314
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010315 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010316
10317
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010318timeout tunnel <timeout>
10319 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10321 yes | no | yes | yes
10322 Arguments :
10323 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10324 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10325 as explained at the top of this document.
10326
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010327 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010328 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10329 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10330 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010331 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10332 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010333 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10334 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10335 specified.
10336
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010337 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10338 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10339 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10340 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10341 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10342 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10343 state.
10344
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010345 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10346 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10347 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10348 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010349 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010350
10351 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10352 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10353 forget about it.
10354
10355 Example :
10356 defaults http
10357 option http-server-close
10358 timeout connect 5s
10359 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010360 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010361 timeout server 30s
10362 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10363
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010364 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010365
10366
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010367transparent (deprecated)
10368 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010370 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010371 Arguments : none
10372
10373 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10374 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10375 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10376 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10377 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10378 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10379 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10380 appropriate server.
10381
10382 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10383
10384 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10385 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10386
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010387 See also: "option transparent"
10388
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010389unique-id-format <string>
10390 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10392 yes | yes | yes | no
10393 Arguments :
10394 <string> is a log-format string.
10395
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010396 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10397 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10398 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10399 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010400
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010401 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10402 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10403 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10404 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10405 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10406 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10407 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10408 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010409
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010410 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10411 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010412
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010413 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010414
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010415 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010416
10417 will generate:
10418
10419 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10420
10421 See also: "unique-id-header"
10422
10423unique-id-header <name>
10424 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10426 yes | yes | yes | no
10427 Arguments :
10428 <name> is the name of the header.
10429
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010430 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10431 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010432
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010433 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010434
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010435 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010436 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10437
10438 will generate:
10439
10440 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10441
10442 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010443
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010444use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010445 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10447 no | yes | yes | no
10448 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010449 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10450 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010451
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010452 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10453 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010454
10455 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10456 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10457 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010458 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010459 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010460 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10461 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010462
10463 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10464 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10465 assign the backend.
10466
10467 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10468 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10469 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10470 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10471 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10472 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10473
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010474 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010475 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010476 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10477 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10478 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10479
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010480 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10481 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10482 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10483 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10484 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10485 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10486 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10487 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10488 cannot be forced from the request.
10489
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010490 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010491 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10492 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10493
10494 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10495 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010496
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020010497use-fcgi-app <name>
10498 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
10499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10500 no | no | yes | yes
10501 Arguments :
10502 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
10503
10504 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010505
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010506use-server <server> if <condition>
10507use-server <server> unless <condition>
10508 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10510 no | no | yes | yes
10511 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010512 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010513
10514 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10515
10516 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10517 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10518 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10519
10520 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10521 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10522 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10523 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10524 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10525 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10526 matches will assign the server.
10527
10528 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10529 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10530 with the next rules until one matches.
10531
10532 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10533 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10534 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10535 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10536
10537 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10538 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10539 stripped.
10540
10541 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10542 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10543 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10544 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10545
10546 Example :
10547 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10548 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10549 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10550 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10551 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10552 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010553 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010554 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10555 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10556
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010557 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010558
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010559
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100105605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010561--------------------------
10562
10563The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10564depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10565settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10566written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10567described in this section.
10568
10569
105705.1. Bind options
10571-----------------
10572
10573The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10574as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10575no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10576parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10577while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10578provided immediately after the setting name.
10579
10580The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10581
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010582accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10583 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10584 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10585 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10586 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10587 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10588 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10589 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10590 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10591 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010592 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10593 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10594 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010595
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010596accept-proxy
10597 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010598 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10599 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010600 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10601 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10602 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10603 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010604 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010605 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10606 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010607 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10608 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010609
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010610allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010611 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010612 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010613 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010614 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10615 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010616
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010617alpn <protocols>
10618 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10619 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10620 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010621 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010622 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010623 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10624 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10625 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10626 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10627 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10628 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10629 preference, like below :
10630
10631 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010632
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010633backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010010634 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010635 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10636
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010637curves <curves>
10638 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10639 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10640 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10641 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10642 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10643 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10644
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010645ecdhe <named curve>
10646 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010647 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10648 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010649
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010650ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010651 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10652 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10653 client's certificate.
10654
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010655ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10656 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10657 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10658 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10659 error is ignored.
10660
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010661ca-sign-file <cafile>
10662 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10663 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10664 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10665 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10666 'generate-certificates' for details.
10667
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010668ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010669 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10670 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10671 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10672 'generate-certificates' for details.
10673
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010674ciphers <ciphers>
10675 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10676 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010677 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010678 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010679 information and recommendations see e.g.
10680 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10681 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10682 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10683
10684ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10685 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10686 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10687 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10688 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010689 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
10690 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010691
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010692crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010693 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10694 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10695 to verify client's certificate.
10696
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010697crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010698 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10699 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10700 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10701 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10702 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10703 file.
10704
10705 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10706 are loaded.
10707
10708 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010709 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010710 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10711 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10712 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10713 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010714 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10715 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010716 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010717
10718 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10719 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10720 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10721 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010722 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10723 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010724
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010725 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010726
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010727 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010728 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010729 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10730 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010731 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10732 clients).
10733
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010734 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10735 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10736 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10737 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10738 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10739 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10740 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10741 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10742 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10743 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10744 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10745 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10746 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10747
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010748 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10749 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10750 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10751 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10752 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10753
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010754 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10755 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10756 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10757 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010758
10759 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10760 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10761 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10762 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10763 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10764 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10765 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10766 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10767 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10768
10769 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10770
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010771 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010772 a cert bundle.
10773
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010774 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010775 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10776 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10777 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10778 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10779 provide multi-cert support.
10780
10781 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10782
10783 Filename | CN | SAN
10784 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10785 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010786 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010787 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10788 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10789
10790 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10791 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10792 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10793 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010794 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10795 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10796 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010797
10798 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10799 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10800
10801 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10802 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10803 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10804
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010805crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010806 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010807 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010808 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010809 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010810
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010811crt-list <file>
10812 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010813 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10814 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010815
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010816 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10817
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010818 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10819 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010820 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010821 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010822
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010823 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10824 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10825 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10826 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10827 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10828 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10829 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10830 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010831
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010832 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010833 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010834 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10835 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10836 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010837
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010838 crt-list file example:
10839 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010840 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010841 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010842 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010843
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010844defer-accept
10845 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10846 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10847 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010848 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010849 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10850 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10851 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10852 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10853 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10854 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10855 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10856
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010857expose-fd listeners
10858 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10859 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010860 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10861 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010862 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010863
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010864force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010865 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010866 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010867 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010868 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010869
10870force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010871 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010872 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010873 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010874
10875force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010876 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010877 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010878 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010879
10880force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010881 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010882 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010883 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010884
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010885force-tlsv13
10886 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10887 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010888 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010889
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010890generate-certificates
10891 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10892 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10893 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10894 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10895 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10896 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10897 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10898 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10899 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10900 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10901 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10902
10903 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10904 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010905 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010906 certificate is used many times.
10907
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010908gid <gid>
10909 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10910 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10911 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10912 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10913 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10914
10915group <group>
10916 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10917 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10918 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10919 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10920 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10921
10922id <id>
10923 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10924 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10925 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10926 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10927
10928interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010929 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10930 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10931 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10932 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10933 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10934 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010010935 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
10936 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
10937 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
10938 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
10939 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
10940 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010941
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010942level <level>
10943 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10944 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10945 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010946 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010947 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10948 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10949 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010950 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010951 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010952 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010953 all counters).
10954
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020010955severity-output <format>
10956 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
10957 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
10958 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
10959 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
10960 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
10961 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
10962 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
10963 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
10964 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
10965 rfc5424 convention.
10966
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010967maxconn <maxconn>
10968 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10969 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10970 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10971 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10972 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10973 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10974 eat all memory.
10975
10976mode <mode>
10977 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10978 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10979 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10980 UNIX sockets.
10981
10982mss <maxseg>
10983 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10984 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10985 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10986 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10987 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10988 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10989 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10990 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10991 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10992 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10993 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10994
10995name <name>
10996 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10997 page.
10998
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010999namespace <name>
11000 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11001 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11002 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11003 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11004
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011005nice <nice>
11006 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11007 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11008 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11009 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11010 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11011 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11012 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11013 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11014 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11015 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11016 one for an RDP socket.
11017
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011018no-ca-names
11019 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11020 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11021
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011022no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011023 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011024 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011025 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011026 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011027 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11028 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011029
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011030no-tls-tickets
11031 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11032 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11033 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011034 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11035 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011036
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011037no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011038 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011039 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011040 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011041 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011042 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11043 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011044
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011045no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011046 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011047 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011048 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011049 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011050 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11051 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011052
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011053no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011054 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011055 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011056 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011057 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011058 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11059 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011060
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011061no-tlsv13
11062 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11063 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11064 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11065 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011066 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11067 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011068
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011069npn <protocols>
11070 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11071 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11072 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011073 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011074 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011075 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11076 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11077 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11078 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11079 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011080
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011081prefer-client-ciphers
11082 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11083 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11084 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011085 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11086 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11087 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011088
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011089process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011090 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011091 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011092 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011093 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11094 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11095 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11096 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011097 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011098 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11099 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11100 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11101 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11102 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011103
11104 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11105
11106 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11107 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11108 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11109 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11110 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11111 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11112 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11113 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011114
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011115proto <name>
11116 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11117 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11118 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11119 in haproxy -vv.
11120 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11121 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011122 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011123 h2" on the bind line.
11124
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011125ssl
11126 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011127 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011128 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11129 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011130 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11131 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011132
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011133ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11134 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11135 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11136 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11137
11138ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11139 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11140 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11141 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11142
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011143strict-sni
11144 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11145 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11146 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11147 See the "crt" option for more information.
11148
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011149tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011150 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011151 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11152 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011153 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011154 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11155 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11156 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11157 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11158 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11159 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11160 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11161
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011162tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011163 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011164 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11165 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11166 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11167 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11168 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11169 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11170 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011171 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11172 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11173 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011174
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011175tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11176 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011177 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11178 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11179 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11180 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11181 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11182 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11183 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11184 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11185 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11186 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011187 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11188 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11189
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011190transparent
11191 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11192 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11193 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11194 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11195 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11196 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11197 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11198 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11199 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11200 so check for support with your vendor.
11201
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011202v4v6
11203 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11204 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11205 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11206 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011207 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011208
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011209v6only
11210 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11211 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11212 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011213 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11214 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011215
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011216uid <uid>
11217 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11218 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11219 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11220 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11221 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11222
11223user <user>
11224 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11225 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11226 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11227 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11228 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11229
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011230verify [none|optional|required]
11231 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11232 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11233 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11234 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11235 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011236 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11237 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11238 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11239 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011240
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200112415.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011242------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011243
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011244The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11245which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11246arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11247settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11248after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11249Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11250address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011252 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011253 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011254
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011255Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11256keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11257
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011258The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011259
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011260addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011261 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011262 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11263 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11264 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11265 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11266 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011267
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011268agent-check
11269 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011270 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011271 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11272 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11273 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011274
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011275 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011276 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011277 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11278 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11279 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011280
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011281 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11282 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11283 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11284 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11285 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011286
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011287 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011288 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011289
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011290 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11291 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11292 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011293
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011294 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11295 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11296 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011297
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011298 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11299 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11300 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11301 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11302 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011303 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011304 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011305
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011306 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11307 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011308
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011309 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11310 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11311 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11312 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11313 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11314 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11315 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11316 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11317 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011318
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011319 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11320 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011321 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11322 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11323 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011324 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011325
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011326 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011327 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011328
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011329agent-send <string>
11330 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11331 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11332 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11333 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11334 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11335
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011336agent-inter <delay>
11337 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11338 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11339
11340 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11341 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11342 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11343 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11344 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11345 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11346 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11347 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11348 of backends use the same servers.
11349
11350 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11351
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011352agent-addr <addr>
11353 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11354
11355 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11356 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11357 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11358 hostname, it will be resolved.
11359
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011360agent-port <port>
11361 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11362
11363 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11364
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011365allow-0rtt
11366 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011367 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11368 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011369
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011370alpn <protocols>
11371 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11372 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11373 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011374 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011375 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11376 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11377 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11378 now obsolete NPN extension.
11379 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11380 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11381
11382 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11383
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011384backup
11385 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11386 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11387 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11388 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011389 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11390 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011391
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011392ca-file <cafile>
11393 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11394 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11395 server's certificate.
11396
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011397check
11398 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011399 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11400 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11401 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11402 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11403 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11404 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11405 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011406 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11407 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011408 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11409 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011410
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011411check-send-proxy
11412 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11413 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11414 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11415 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11416 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11417 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11418 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11419
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011420check-alpn <protocols>
11421 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11422 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11423 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11424
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011425check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011426 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011427 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11428 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011429
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011430check-ssl
11431 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11432 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11433 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11434 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011435 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011436 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11437 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011438 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011439 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11440 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011441
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011442check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011443 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011444 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
11445 for normal traffic.
11446
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011447ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011448 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11449 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11450 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011451 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11452 information and recommendations see e.g.
11453 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11454 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11455 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011456
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011457ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11458 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11459 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11460 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11461 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011462 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11463 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11464 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011465
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011466cookie <value>
11467 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11468 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11469 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11470 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11471 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11472 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11473 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11474
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011475crl-file <crlfile>
11476 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11477 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11478 to verify server's certificate.
11479
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011480crt <cert>
11481 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11482 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11483 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11484 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11485 certificate request.
11486
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011487disabled
11488 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11489 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11490 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11491 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11492 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011493 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011494
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011495enabled
11496 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11497 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11498 default value.
11499 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11500 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011501
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011502error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011503 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11504 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11505 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011506
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011507 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011508
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011509fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011510 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11511 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11512 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11513
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011514force-sslv3
11515 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11516 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011517 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011518 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011519
11520force-tlsv10
11521 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011522 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011523 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011524
11525force-tlsv11
11526 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011527 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011528 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011529
11530force-tlsv12
11531 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011532 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011533 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011534
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011535force-tlsv13
11536 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11537 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011538 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011539
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011540id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011541 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11542 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11543 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011544
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011545init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11546 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11547 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011548 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011549 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11550 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11551 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11552 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11553 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11554 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11555 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11556 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11557 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011558 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011559 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11560 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11561 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11562 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11563 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11564 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011565 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011566
11567 Example:
11568 defaults
11569 # never fail on address resolution
11570 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11571
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011572inter <delay>
11573fastinter <delay>
11574downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011575 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11576 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11577 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11578 between checks depending on the server state :
11579
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011580 Server state | Interval used
11581 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11582 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11583 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11584 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11585 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11586 or yet unchecked. |
11587 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11588 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11589 | "inter" otherwise.
11590 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011592 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11593 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11594 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11595 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011596 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11597 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11598 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11599 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11600 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011601
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011602maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011603 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11604 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11605 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11606 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11607 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11608 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11609 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11610 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11611
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011612maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011613 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11614 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11615 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11616 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11617 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11618 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11619 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11620
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011621max-reuse <count>
11622 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11623 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11624 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11625 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11626 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11627 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11628 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11629 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11630
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011631minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011632 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11633 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11634 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11635 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11636 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11637 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011638 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011639 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011640
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011641namespace <name>
11642 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11643 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11644 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11645 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11646
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011647no-agent-check
11648 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11649 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11650 default value.
11651 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11652 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11653
11654no-backup
11655 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11656 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11657 default value.
11658 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11659 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11660
11661no-check
11662 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11663 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11664 default value.
11665 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11666 "default-server" "check" setting.
11667
11668no-check-ssl
11669 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11670 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11671 default value.
11672 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11673 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11674
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011675no-send-proxy
11676 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11677 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11678 default value.
11679 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11680 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11681
11682no-send-proxy-v2
11683 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11684 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11685 default value.
11686 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11687 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11688
11689no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11690 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11691 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11692 default value.
11693 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11694 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11695
11696no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11697 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11698 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11699 default value.
11700 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11701 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11702
11703no-ssl
11704 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11705 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11706 default value.
11707 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11708 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11709
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011710no-ssl-reuse
11711 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11712 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11713 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11714 and for paranoid users.
11715
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011716no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011717 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11718 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011719 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011720
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011721 Supported in default-server: No
11722
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011723no-tls-tickets
11724 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11725 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11726 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011727 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11728 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011729 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011730
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011731no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011732 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011733 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11734 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011735 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11736 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011737 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011738
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011739 Supported in default-server: No
11740
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011741no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011742 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011743 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11744 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011745 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11746 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011747 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011748
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011749 Supported in default-server: No
11750
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011751no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011752 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011753 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11754 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011755 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11756 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011757 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011758
11759 Supported in default-server: No
11760
11761no-tlsv13
11762 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11763 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11764 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11765 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11766 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011767 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011768
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011769 Supported in default-server: No
11770
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011771no-verifyhost
11772 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11773 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11774 default value.
11775 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11776 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011777
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020011778no-tfo
11779 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
11780 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11781 default value.
11782 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11783 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
11784
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011785non-stick
11786 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11787 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11788 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11789
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011790npn <protocols>
11791 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11792 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11793 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011794 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011795 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
11796 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11797 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
11798
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011799observe <mode>
11800 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11801 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11802 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11803 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11804 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11805 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011806 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011807
11808 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11809
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011810on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011811 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11812 Currently, four modes are available:
11813 - fastinter: force fastinter
11814 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11815 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11816 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11817 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11818
11819 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11820
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011821on-marked-down <action>
11822 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11823 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011824 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11825 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11826 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11827 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11828 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11829 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11830 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11831 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011832
11833 Actions are disabled by default
11834
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011835on-marked-up <action>
11836 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11837 Currently one action is available:
11838 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11839 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11840 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11841 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011842 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11843 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011844 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11845 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11846
11847 Actions are disabled by default
11848
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010011849pool-max-conn <max>
11850 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
11851 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
11852 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
11853 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
11854 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
11855 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
11856
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010011857pool-purge-delay <delay>
11858 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010011859 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020011860 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010011861
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011862port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011863 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11864 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11865 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11866 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11867 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11868 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11869
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020011870proto <name>
11871
11872 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
11873 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
11874 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
11875 reported in haproxy -vv.
11876 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11877 protocol for all connections established to this server.
11878
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011879redir <prefix>
11880 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11881 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11882 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11883 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11884 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11885 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11886 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11887 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011888 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011889 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011890 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11891 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11892 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11893 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11894
11895 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11896
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011897rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011898 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11899 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11900 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11901
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020011902resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
11903 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
11904 server.
11905
11906 Available options:
11907
11908 * allow-dup-ip
11909 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
11910 resolution at runtime is in operation.
11911 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
11912 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
11913 For such case, simply enable this option.
11914 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
11915
11916 * prevent-dup-ip
11917 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
11918 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
11919 same fqdn.
11920 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
11921
11922 Example:
11923 backend b_myapp
11924 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
11925 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
11926 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
11927
11928 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
11929 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
11930 it
11931 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
11932 different address
11933
11934 Default value: not set
11935
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011936resolve-prefer <family>
11937 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11938 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11939 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11940 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11941
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011942 Default value: ipv6
11943
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011944 Example:
11945
11946 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011947
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011948resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011949 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011950 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011951 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011952 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11953 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011954 configured network, another address is selected.
11955
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011956 Example:
11957
11958 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011959
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011960resolvers <id>
11961 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11962 hostname.
11963
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011964 Example:
11965
11966 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011967
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011968 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011969
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011970send-proxy
11971 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11972 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11973 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11974 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011975 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11976 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11977 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11978 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11979 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11980 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11981 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11982 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11983 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11984 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011985 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11986 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011987
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011988send-proxy-v2
11989 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11990 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11991 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11992 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020011993 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
11994 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
11995 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
11996 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011997
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010011998proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
11999 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12000 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012001 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12002 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012003 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12004 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012005 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012006
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012007send-proxy-v2-ssl
12008 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12009 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12010 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12011 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12012 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12013 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12014 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012015 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12016 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012017
12018send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12019 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12020 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12021 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12022 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12023 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12024 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12025 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12026 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012027 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12028 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012029
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012030slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012031 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12032 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12033 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12034 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12035 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12036 parameters :
12037
12038 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12039 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12040
12041 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12042 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12043 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12044 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12045
12046 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12047 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12048 seen as failed.
12049
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012050sni <expression>
12051 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12052 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12053 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12054 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012055 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12056 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012057 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012058 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12059 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012060
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012061source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012062source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012063source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012064 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12065 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12066 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12067 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12068
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012069 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12070 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12071 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12072 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12073 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12074 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12075 server.
12076
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012077 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12078 specifying the source address without port(s).
12079
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012080ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012081 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12082 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12083 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12084 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12085 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12086 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012087 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12088 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012089
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012090ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12091 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12092 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12093 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12094
12095ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12096 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12097 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12098 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12099
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012100ssl-reuse
12101 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12102 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12103 default value.
12104 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12105 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12106
12107stick
12108 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12109 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12110 default value.
12111 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12112 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012113
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012114socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012115 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012116 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12117 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12118
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012119tcp-ut <delay>
12120 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12121 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12122 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012123 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012124 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12125 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12126 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12127 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12128 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12129 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12130 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12131 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12132 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12133
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012134tfo
12135 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12136 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12137 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12138 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12139 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012140 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012141
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012142track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012143 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12144 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12145 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12146 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012147 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12148
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012149tls-tickets
12150 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12151 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12152 default value.
12153 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12154 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012155
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012156verify [none|required]
12157 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012158 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012159 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12160 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012161 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012162 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12163 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12164 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12165 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12166 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12167 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12168 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12169 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012170
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012171verifyhost <hostname>
12172 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012173 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12174 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12175 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12176 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12177 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12178 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12179 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12180 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012181
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012182weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012183 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12184 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12185 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012186 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12187 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12188 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12189 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12190 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12191 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012192
12193
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200121945.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12195-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012196
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012197HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12198using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12199configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012200This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12201can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12202workload.
12203This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12204resolution at run time.
12205Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12206carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12207
12208
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200122095.3.1. Global overview
12210----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012211
12212As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12213different steps of the process life:
12214
12215 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12216 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12217 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12218
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012219 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12220 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012221
12222A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12223 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12224 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12225 resolution to know this new IP.
12226
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012227When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012228HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012229SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12230from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12231will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12232will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012233
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012234A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012235 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012236 first valid response.
12237
12238 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12239 servers return an error.
12240
12241
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200122425.3.2. The resolvers section
12243----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012244
12245This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012246HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12247contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012248
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012249When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12250uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12251is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12252answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12253
12254When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012255used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012256
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012257 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12258 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12259 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012260
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012261 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12262 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012263
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012264 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12265 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12266 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012267
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012268For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12269following scenarios are possible:
12270
12271 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12272 ignored
12273
12274 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12275 applied
12276
12277 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12278 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12279
12280 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12281 retries the query with a new type
12282
12283 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12284 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012285
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012286As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12287a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012288<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012289
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012290
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012291resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012292 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012293
12294A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12295
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012296accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012297 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012298 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012299 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12300 by RFC 6891)
12301
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012302 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12303
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012304nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12305 DNS server description:
12306 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12307 <ip> : IP address of the server
12308 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12309
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012310parse-resolv-conf
12311 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12312 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12313 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12314
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012315hold <status> <period>
12316 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12317 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012318 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012319 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012320 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12321 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12322 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12323
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012324 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012325
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012326resolve_retries <nb>
12327 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12328 giving up.
12329 Default value: 3
12330
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012331 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12332 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12333 type.
12334
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012335timeout <event> <time>
12336 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12337 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12338 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012339 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12340 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012341 Default value: 1s
12342 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012343 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012344 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012345 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12346 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12347
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012348 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012349
12350 resolvers mydns
12351 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12352 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012353 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012354 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012355 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012356 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012357 hold other 30s
12358 hold refused 30s
12359 hold nx 30s
12360 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012361 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012362 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012363
12364
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200123656. Cache
12366---------
12367
12368HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
12369(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
12370RAM.
12371
12372The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
12373this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
12374
12375If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
12376independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
12377when we try to allocate a new one.
12378
12379The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
12380
12381It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
12382"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
12383for more details.
12384
12385When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
12386replaced by "<CACHE>".
12387
12388
123896.1. Limitation
12390----------------
12391
12392The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
12393
12394- If the response is not a 200
12395- If the response contains a Vary header
12396- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
12397- If the response is not cacheable
12398
12399- If the request is not a GET
12400- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
12401- If the request contains an Authorization header
12402
12403
124046.2. Setup
12405-----------
12406
12407To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
12408the corresponding http-request and response actions.
12409
12410
124116.2.1. Cache section
12412---------------------
12413
12414cache <name>
12415 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
12416 size of cache is mandatory.
12417
12418total-max-size <megabytes>
12419 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
12420 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
12421
12422max-object-size <bytes>
12423 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
12424 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
12425 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
12426
12427max-age <seconds>
12428 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
12429 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
12430 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
12431 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
12432 default.
12433
12434
124356.2.2. Proxy section
12436---------------------
12437
12438http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12439 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
12440 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
12441 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
12442 after this one.
12443
12444http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12445 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
12446 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
12447 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
12448 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
12449
12450
12451Example:
12452
12453 backend bck1
12454 mode http
12455
12456 http-request cache-use foobar
12457 http-response cache-store foobar
12458 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
12459
12460 cache foobar
12461 total-max-size 4
12462 max-age 240
12463
12464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200124657. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12466----------------------------------
12467
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012468HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012469client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12470The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12471these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12472but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12473data called patterns.
12474
12475
124767.1. ACL basics
12477---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012478
12479The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12480content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12481from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12482simple :
12483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012484 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012485 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012486 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12487 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012489The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12490adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012491
12492In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012494 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012495
12496This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12497Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12498and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012499an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12500conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12501as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12502are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012503
12504ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12505'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12506which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12507
12508There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12509performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012511The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12512specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12513this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012514methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12515ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012516
12517Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12518 - boolean
12519 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12520 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12521 - string
12522 - data block
12523
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012524Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12525converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12526would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12527The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12528which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12529
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012530Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12531keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12532fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12533which are summarized in the table below :
12534
12535 +---------------------+-----------------+
12536 | Sample or converter | Default |
12537 | output type | matching method |
12538 +---------------------+-----------------+
12539 | boolean | bool |
12540 +---------------------+-----------------+
12541 | integer | int |
12542 +---------------------+-----------------+
12543 | ip | ip |
12544 +---------------------+-----------------+
12545 | string | str |
12546 +---------------------+-----------------+
12547 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12548 +---------------------+-----------------+
12549
12550Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12551matching method, see below.
12552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012553The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12554 - boolean
12555 - integer or integer range
12556 - IP address / network
12557 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12558 - regular expression
12559 - hex block
12560
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012561The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12562
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012563 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12564 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012565 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012566 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012567 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012568 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012569 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012571The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12572read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12573if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12574lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12575will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12576beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12577a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12578lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12579exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12580
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012581The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12582parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12583ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12584a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12585check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12586
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012587The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12588socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12589file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012591Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12592loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12593
12594 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12595
12596In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12597the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12598case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12599as well.
12600
12601The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12602sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12603do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12604methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12605is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012606obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012607followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12608default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12609that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12610string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12611
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012612The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12613By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12614string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12615resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12616server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012617waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012618flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12619function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012621There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12622sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12623be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012624
12625 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12626 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012627 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12628 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12629 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12630 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012631
12632 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12633 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012634 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012635
12636 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012637 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012638
12639 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012640 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012641
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012642 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012643 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12644
12645 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12646 binary or string samples.
12647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012648 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12649 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012651 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12652 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12653 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012655 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12656 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012658 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12659 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012661 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12662 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012664 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12665 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012666 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012668 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12669 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12670 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012671
12672For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12673request, it is possible to do :
12674
12675 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12676
12677In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12678buffer, one would use the following acl :
12679
12680 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12681
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012682On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12683possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12684
12685 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012687All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12688criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12689method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12690to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12691criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12692the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012694If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012695the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12696For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012698 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12699 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12700 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12701 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012702
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012703
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012704The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12705types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12706combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12707brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12708default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012710 +-------------------------------------------------+
12711 | Input sample type |
12712 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012713 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012714 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12715 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12716 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012717 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012718 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012719 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012720 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012721 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012722 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012723 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012724 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012725 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012726 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012727 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012728 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012729 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012730 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012731 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012732 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012733 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012734 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012735 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012736 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012737 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012738 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12739 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12740 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012741
12742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200127437.1.1. Matching booleans
12744------------------------
12745
12746In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12747Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12748When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12749that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12750
12751Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12752return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12753"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12754
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200127567.1.2. Matching integers
12757------------------------
12758
12759Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12760enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12761to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12762
12763Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12764matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12765lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012766
12767For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12768unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12769representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12770
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012771As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12772two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12773instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12774ranges and operators.
12775
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012776For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012777operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12778Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12779of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012780
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012781Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012782
12783 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12784 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12785 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12786 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12787 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12788
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012789For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012790
12791 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12792
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012793This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12794
12795 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12796
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200127987.1.3. Matching strings
12799-----------------------
12800
12801String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12802different forms :
12803
12804 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012805 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012806
12807 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012808 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012809
12810 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12811 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12812
12813 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12814 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12815
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012816 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012817 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12818 matches.
12819
12820 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12821 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12822 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012823
12824String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12825exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12826characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12827string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12828to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012829before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012830
12831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128327.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12833---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012834
12835Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12836they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12837possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12838passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12839the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012840the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12841match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012842
12843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128447.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12845-------------------------------------
12846
12847It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12848not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12849a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12850to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12851digits may be used upper or lower case.
12852
12853Example :
12854 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12855 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12856
12857
128587.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12859---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012860
12861IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12862netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12863within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012864host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012865difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12866at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12867does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12868parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012869
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012870The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12871abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12872
12873 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12874 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12875 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12876 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12877 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12878 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12879 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12880 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12881
12882Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12883192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12884
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012885IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12886Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12887trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12888IPv6 patterns.
12889
12890HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12891following situations :
12892 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12893 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12894 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12895 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12896 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12897 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12898 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12899 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12900 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12901 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012903
129047.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12905----------------------------------
12906
12907Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12908combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12909
12910 - AND (implicit)
12911 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12912 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012914A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012916 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012918Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12919indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012921For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12922"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12923requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12924is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12925
12926 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012927 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12928 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12929 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012930
12931To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12932and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12933
12934 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12935 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12936 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12937 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12938
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012939 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012940 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12941 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12942 use_backend www if host_www
12943
12944It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12945expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12946be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12947the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12948
12949 The following rule :
12950
12951 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012952 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012953
12954 Can also be written that way :
12955
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012956 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012957
12958It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12959to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12960simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12961sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12962good use is the following :
12963
12964 With named ACLs :
12965
12966 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12967 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12968 monitor fail if site_dead
12969
12970 With anonymous ACLs :
12971
12972 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12973
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012974See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
12975keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012976
12977
129787.3. Fetching samples
12979---------------------
12980
12981Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12982against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12983sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12984ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12985of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12986available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12987
12988This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12989Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12990compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12991deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12992
12993The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12994matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12995method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12996indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12997
12998As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12999when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13000mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13001the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13002ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13003
13004Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13005multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13006when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013007incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13008are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013009is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13010all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13011
13012Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13013 - name
13014 - name(arg1)
13015 - name(arg1,arg2)
13016
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013017
130187.3.1. Converters
13019-----------------
13020
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013021Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13022of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13023is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13024was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013025has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013026unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13027
13028These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13029sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13030the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013031support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013032
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013033A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13034support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13035supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13036(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13037bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013039The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013040
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001304151d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13042 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13043 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13044 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13045 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13046 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13047
13048 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013049 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13050 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013051 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13052 frontend http-in
13053 bind *:8081
13054 default_backend servers
13055 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13056 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13057
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013058add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013059 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013060 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013061 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13062 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013063 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013064 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13065 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13066 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13067 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013068 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013069 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013070
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013071aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13072 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13073 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13074 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13075 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13076 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13077 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13078
13079 Example:
13080 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13081 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13082
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013083and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013084 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013085 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013086 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13087 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013088 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013089 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13090 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13091 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13092 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013093 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013094 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013095
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013096b64dec
13097 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13098 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13099
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013100base64
13101 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013102 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013103 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13104
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013105bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013106 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013107 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013108 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013109 presence of a flag).
13110
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013111bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13112 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13113 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013114 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013115
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013116concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13117 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13118 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13119 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13120 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13121 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13122 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13123 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13124 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13125 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13126 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013127 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013128 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013129 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013130
13131 Example:
13132 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13133 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13134 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13135 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13136
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013137cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013138 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13139 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013140
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013141crc32([<avalanche>])
13142 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13143 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13144 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13145 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13146 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13147 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13148 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13149 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13150 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13151 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013152 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13153
13154crc32c([<avalanche>])
13155 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13156 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13157 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13158 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13159 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13160 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13161 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13162 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013163
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013164da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013165 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13166 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13167 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13168 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013169 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013170 configuration language.
13171
13172 Example:
13173 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013174 bind *:8881
13175 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013176 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013177
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013178debug
13179 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13180 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13181 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13182
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013183div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013184 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13185 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013186 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013187 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13188 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013189 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013190 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13191 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13192 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13193 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013194 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013195 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013196
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013197djb2([<avalanche>])
13198 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13199 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13200 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13201 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13202 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13203 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13204 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013205 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13206 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013207
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013208even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013209 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013210 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13211
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013212field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13213 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13214 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13215 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13216 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13217 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13218 fields.
13219
13220 Example :
13221 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13222 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13223 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13224 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13225 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013226
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013227hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013228 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013229 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013230 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013231 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013232
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013233hex2i
13234 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013235 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013236
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013237http_date([<offset>])
13238 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13239 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13240 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13241 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13242 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13243 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013244
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013245in_table(<table>)
13246 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13247 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13248 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013249 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013250 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13251
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013252ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13253 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013254 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013255 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13256 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13257 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13258 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13259 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013260
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013261json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013262 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013263 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013264 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013265 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13266 of errors:
13267 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13268 bytes, ...)
13269 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13270 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13271
13272 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13273 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13274 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13275 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13276 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13277 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013278 - "ascii" : never fails;
13279 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13280 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013281 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013282 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013283 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13284 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13285
13286 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013287 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013288
13289 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013290 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013291 capture request header user-agent len 150
13292 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013293
13294 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13295 GET / HTTP/1.0
13296 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13297
13298 Output log:
13299 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13300
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013301language(<value>[,<default>])
13302 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13303 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13304 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13305 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13306 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13307 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13308 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13309 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13310 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013311 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013312 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13313 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013314
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013315 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013316
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013317 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13318 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013319
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013320 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13321 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13322 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13323 use_backend spanish if es
13324 use_backend french if fr
13325 use_backend english if en
13326 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013327
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013328length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013329 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13330 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13331 type. The result is of type integer.
13332
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013333lower
13334 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13335 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13336 type. The result is of type string.
13337
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013338ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13339 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13340 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13341 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13342 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13343 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13344 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13345
13346 Example :
13347
13348 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013349 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013350 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13351
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013352map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13353map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13354map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13355 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13356 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13357 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13358 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13359 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13360 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13361 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13362 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013363
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013364 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13365 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13366 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013367
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013368 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013369 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013370
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013371 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13372 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13373 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13374 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013375 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13376 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013377 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13378 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13379 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13380 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13381 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13382 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13383 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13384 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013385 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13386 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13387 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013388 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13389 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13390 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13391 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13392 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013393
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013394 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13395 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13396 the corresponding match text.
13397
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013398 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13399 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13400 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13401 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13402 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013403
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013404 Example :
13405
13406 # this is a comment and is ignored
13407 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13408 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13409 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13410 | | | `---------- value
13411 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13412 | `---------------------------- key
13413 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13414
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013415mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013416 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13417 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013418 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013419 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013420 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013421 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13422 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13423 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13424 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013425 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013426 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013427
13428mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013429 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013430 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13431 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013432 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013433 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013434 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013435 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13436 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13437 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13438 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013439 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013440 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013441
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013442nbsrv
13443 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13444 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13445 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13446 map lookup.
13447
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013448neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013449 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13450 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13451 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13452 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013453
13454not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013455 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013456 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013457 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013458 absence of a flag).
13459
13460odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013461 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013462 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13463
13464or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013465 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013466 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013467 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13468 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013469 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013470 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13471 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13472 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13473 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013474 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013475 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013476
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013477protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13478 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13479 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13480 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13481 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13482 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13483 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13484 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13485 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13486 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13487 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13488 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13489
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013490regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013491 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13492 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13493 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13494 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13495 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13496 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13497 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13498 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13499 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13500 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013501 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13502 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13503 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13504 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013505
13506 Example :
13507
13508 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13509 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13510 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13511 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13512
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013513capture-req(<id>)
13514 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13515 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13516
13517 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013518 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13519 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013520
13521capture-res(<id>)
13522 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13523 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13524
13525 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013526 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13527 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013528
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013529sdbm([<avalanche>])
13530 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13531 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13532 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13533 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13534 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13535 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13536 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013537 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13538 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013539
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013540set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013541 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13542 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13543 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013544 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013545 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13546 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013547 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013548 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13549 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013550 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013551 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013552
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013553sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013554 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013555 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13556
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013557sha2([<bits>])
13558 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
13559 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
13560
13561 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
13562 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
13563
13564 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
13565 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
13566
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020013567srv_queue
13568 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
13569 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
13570 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
13571 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
13572 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
13573
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013574strcmp(<var>)
13575 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13576 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13577 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13578 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13579 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13580 shorter).
13581
13582 Example :
13583
13584 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13585 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13586 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13587
13588
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013589sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013590 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13591 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013592 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013593 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13594 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013595 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013596 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13597 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013598 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013599 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13600 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013601 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013602 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013603
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013604table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13605 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13606 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13607 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13608 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13609 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13610 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13611
13612
13613table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13614 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13615 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13616 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13617 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13618 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13619 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13620
13621table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13622 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13623 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013624 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013625 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13626 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13627
13628table_conn_cur(<table>)
13629 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13630 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13631 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13632 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13633 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13634
13635table_conn_rate(<table>)
13636 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13637 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13638 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13639 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13640 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13641
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013642table_gpt0(<table>)
13643 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13644 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13645 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13646 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13647 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13648
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013649table_gpc0(<table>)
13650 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13651 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13652 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13653 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13654 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13655
13656table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13657 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13658 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13659 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13660 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13661 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13662 sample fetch keyword.
13663
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013664table_gpc1(<table>)
13665 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13666 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13667 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13668 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13669 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13670
13671table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13672 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13673 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13674 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13675 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13676 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13677 sample fetch keyword.
13678
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013679table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13680 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13681 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013682 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013683 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13684 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13685
13686table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13687 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13688 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13689 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13690 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13691 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13692 keyword.
13693
13694table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13695 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13696 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013697 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013698 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13699 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13700
13701table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13702 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13703 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13704 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13705 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13706 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13707 keyword.
13708
13709table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13710 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13711 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013712 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013713 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13714 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13715 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13716 keyword.
13717
13718table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13719 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13720 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013721 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013722 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13723 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13724 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13725 keyword.
13726
13727table_server_id(<table>)
13728 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13729 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13730 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13731 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13732 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13733 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13734
13735table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13736 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13737 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013738 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013739 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13740 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13741 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13742 keyword.
13743
13744table_sess_rate(<table>)
13745 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13746 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13747 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13748 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13749 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13750 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13751 keyword.
13752
13753table_trackers(<table>)
13754 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13755 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13756 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13757 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13758 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13759 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13760 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13761 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13762 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13763 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13764
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013765upper
13766 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13767 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13768 type. The result is of type string.
13769
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013770url_dec
13771 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13772 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13773
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013774ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013775 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013776 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
13777 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
13778 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013779 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13780 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13781 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13782 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013783 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013784 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13785 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013786
13787 Example:
13788 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
13789 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
13790
13791 message Point {
13792 int32 latitude = 1;
13793 int32 longitude = 2;
13794 }
13795
13796 message PPoint {
13797 Point point = 59;
13798 }
13799
13800 message Rectangle {
13801 // One corner of the rectangle.
13802 PPoint lo = 48;
13803 // The other corner of the rectangle.
13804 PPoint hi = 49;
13805 }
13806
13807 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
13808 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
13809 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
13810
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013811 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13812 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013813 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013814 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
13815
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013816 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013817
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013818 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013819
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013820 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013821 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13822 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
13823
13824 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
13825 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
13826 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
13827
13828 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
13829 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
13830 interpret the previous binary sample.
13831
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013832
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013833unset-var(<var name>)
13834 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13835 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13836 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13837 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13838 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13839 response),
13840 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13841 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13842 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13843 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13844
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013845utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13846 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13847 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13848 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13849 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13850 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13851 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13852
13853 Example :
13854
13855 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013856 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013857 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13858
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013859word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13860 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
13861 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
13862 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13863 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
13864 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
13865
13866 Example :
13867 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
13868 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13869 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
13870 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
13871 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013872
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013873wt6([<avalanche>])
13874 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13875 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13876 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13877 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13878 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13879 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13880 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013881 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
13882 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013883
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013884xor(<value>)
13885 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013886 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013887 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013888 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013889 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013890 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13891 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013892 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013893 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13894 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013895 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013896 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013897
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013898xxh32([<seed>])
13899 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13900 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13901 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13902 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13903 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13904 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13905 as cryptographically secure.
13906
13907xxh64([<seed>])
13908 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13909 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13910 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13911 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13912 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13913 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13914 as cryptographically secure.
13915
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013916
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200139177.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013918--------------------------------------------
13919
13920A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13921not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13922"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13923The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13924
13925always_false : boolean
13926 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13927 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13928
13929always_true : boolean
13930 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13931 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13932
13933avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013934 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013935 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13936 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13937 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13938 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13939 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13940 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13941 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13942 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13943 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13944 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13945 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13946 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13947 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013949be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013950 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13951 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13952 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13953 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040013954 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
13955
13956be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
13957 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
13958 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
13959 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
13960 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
13961 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040013962 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
13963 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040013964
13965 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
13966 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
13967 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013969be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13970 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13971 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13972 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013973 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013974 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13975 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013976
13977 Example :
13978 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13979 backend dynamic
13980 mode http
13981 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13982 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013983
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013984bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013985 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13986 of the string.
13987
13988bool(<bool>) : bool
13989 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13990 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013992connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13993 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013994 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013995 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13996 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013997
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013998 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013999 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014000 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14001
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014002 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14003 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014004
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014005 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014006 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014007 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014008 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014009 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014010 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014011 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014012
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014013 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14014 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014015 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014016 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014017
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014018cpu_calls : integer
14019 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14020 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14021 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14022 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14023 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14024 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14025
14026cpu_ns_avg : integer
14027 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14028 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14029 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14030 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14031 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14032 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14033 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14034 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14035 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14036 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14037 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14038
14039cpu_ns_tot : integer
14040 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14041 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14042 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14043 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14044 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14045 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14046 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14047 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14048 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14049 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14050 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14051 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14052 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14053
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014054date([<offset>]) : integer
14055 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14056 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14057 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14058 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014059 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14060
14061 Example :
14062
14063 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14064 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014065
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014066date_us : integer
14067 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14068 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14069 from the same timeval structure.
14070
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014071distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14072 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14073 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14074 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14075 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14076 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14077 list of supported tokens.
14078
14079distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14080 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14081 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14082 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14083 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14084 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14085 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14086 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14087 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14088 supported tokens.
14089
14090 Example :
14091 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14092 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14093 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14094 # send large files to the big farm
14095 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14096
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014097env(<name>) : string
14098 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14099 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14100 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14101 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14102 certain way.
14103
14104 Examples :
14105 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14106 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14107
14108 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14109 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014111fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14112 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014113 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14114 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014115 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14116 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014117 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014118 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14119 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014120
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014121fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14122 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14123 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14124 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014126fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14127 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14128 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14129 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14130 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14131 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14132 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14133 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14134 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014135
14136 Example :
14137 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14138 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14139 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14140 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14141 frontend mail
14142 bind :25
14143 mode tcp
14144 maxconn 100
14145 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14146 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14147 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14148 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014149
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014150hostname : string
14151 Returns the system hostname.
14152
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014153int(<integer>) : signed integer
14154 Returns a signed integer.
14155
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014156ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14157 Returns an ipv4.
14158
14159ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14160 Returns an ipv6.
14161
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014162lat_ns_avg : integer
14163 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14164 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14165 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14166 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14167 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14168 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14169 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14170 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14171 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14172 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14173 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14174 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14175 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14176 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14177
14178lat_ns_tot : integer
14179 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14180 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14181 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14182 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14183 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14184 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14185 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14186 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14187 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14188 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14189 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14190 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14191 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14192 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14193 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14194 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14195 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14196 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14197 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14198
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014199meth(<method>) : method
14200 Returns a method.
14201
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014202nbproc : integer
14203 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14204 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14205 and debugging purposes.
14206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014207nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14208 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14209 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14210 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014211 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14212 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14213 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014214
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014215prio_class : integer
14216 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14217 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14218 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14219
14220prio_offset : integer
14221 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14222 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14223 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14224 set-priority-offset".
14225
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014226proc : integer
14227 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14228 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14229 debugging purposes.
14230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014231queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014232 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14233 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14234 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014235 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14236 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14237 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14238 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14239 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14240
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014241rand([<range>]) : integer
14242 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14243 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14244 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14245 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14246 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14247
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014248uuid([<version>]) : string
14249 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14250 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14251 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014253srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14254 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14255 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14256 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14257 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14258 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014259 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14260 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14261
14262srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14263 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14264 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14265 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14266 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14267 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14268 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14269 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14270
14271 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14272 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014273
14274srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14275 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14276 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14277 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014278 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014279 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14280 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14281 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14282
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014283srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14284 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14285 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14286 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14287 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14288 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14289 fetch methods.
14290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014291srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14292 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14293 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014294 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014295 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14296 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014297 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014298 overloading servers).
14299
14300 Example :
14301 # Redirect to a separate back
14302 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14303 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14304 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14305
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014306stopping : boolean
14307 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14308 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14309 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14310
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014311str(<string>) : string
14312 Returns a string.
14313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014314table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14315 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14316 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14317
14318table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14319 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14320 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14321 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14322
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014323thread : integer
14324 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14325 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14326 and debugging purposes.
14327
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014328var(<var-name>) : undefined
14329 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014330 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14331 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014332 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014333 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14334 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014335 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014336 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14337 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014338 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014339 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014340
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200143417.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014342----------------------------------
14343
14344The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14345closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14346methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14347sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14348TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014349the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14350counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014351"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14352used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14353can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14354Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14355table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14356tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14357currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014358
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014359bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014360 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14361 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14362 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014364be_id : integer
14365 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14366 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14367
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014368be_name : string
14369 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14370 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014372dst : ip
14373 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14374 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14375 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14376 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014377 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14378 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14379 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14380 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14381 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14382 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014383
14384dst_conn : integer
14385 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14386 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14387 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14388 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14389 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14390 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14391 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14392 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014393
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014394dst_is_local : boolean
14395 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14396 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14397 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14398 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014399 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014400 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14401 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14402 it only once per connection.
14403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014404dst_port : integer
14405 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14406 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14407 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14408 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14409 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14410 an HTTP header.
14411
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014412fc_http_major : integer
14413 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14414 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14415 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14416
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020014417fc_pp_authority : string
14418 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
14419 if any.
14420
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014421fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14422 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14423 header.
14424
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014425fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14426 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14427 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14428 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14429 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14430 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14431 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14432
14433fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14434 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14435 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14436 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14437 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14438 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14439 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14440
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014441fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014442 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14443 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14444 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14445 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14446
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014447fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014448 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14449 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14450 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14451 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14452
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014453fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014454 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14455 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14456 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14457 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14458
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014459fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014460 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14461 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14462 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14463 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14464
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014465fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014466 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14467 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14468 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14469 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14470
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014471fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014472 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14473 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14474 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14475 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14476
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014477fe_defbe : string
14478 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14479 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014481fe_id : integer
14482 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014483 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014484 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14485
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014486fe_name : string
14487 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14488 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14489 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14490
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014491sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014492sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14493sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14494sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014495 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14496 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14497 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14498
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014499sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014500sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14501sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14502sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014503 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14504 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14505 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14506
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014507sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014508sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14509sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14510sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014511 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14512 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014513 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14514 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14515 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014516
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014517 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014518 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14519 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014520 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14521 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14522 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014523 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14524 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14525
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014526sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14527sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14528sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14529sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14530 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14531 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14532 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14533 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14534 when a first ACL was verified.
14535
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014536sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014537sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14538sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14539sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014540 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014541 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14542
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014543sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014544sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14545sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14546sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014547 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14548 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14549 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14550
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014551sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014552sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14553sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14554sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014555 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14556 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14557 See also src_conn_rate.
14558
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014559sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014560sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14561sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14562sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014563 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014564 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014565
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014566sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14567sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14568sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14569sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14570 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14571 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14572
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014573sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14574sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14575sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14576sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14577 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14578 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14579
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014580sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014581sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14582sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14583sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014584 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14585 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14586 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014587 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14588 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14589 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014590
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014591sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14592sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14593sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14594sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14595 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14596 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14597 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14598 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14599 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14600 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14601
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014602sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014603sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14604sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14605sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014606 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014607 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14608 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14609
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014610sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014611sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14612sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14613sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014614 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14615 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14616 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14617 src_http_err_rate.
14618
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014619sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014620sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14621sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14622sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014623 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014624 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14625 src_http_req_cnt.
14626
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014627sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014628sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14629sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14630sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014631 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14632 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14633 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14634 src_http_req_rate.
14635
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014636sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014637sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14638sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14639sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014640 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014641 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14642 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14643 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14644 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014645
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014646 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014647 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14648 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014649 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14650
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014651sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14652sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14653sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14654sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14655 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14656 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14657 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14658 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14659 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14660
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014661sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014662sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14663sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14664sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014665 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14666 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14667 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014668
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014669sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014670sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14671sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14672sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014673 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14674 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14675 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014676
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014677sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014678sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14679sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14680sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014681 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014682 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14683 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14684 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014685 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014686 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14687
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014688sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014689sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14690sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14691sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014692 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14693 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14694 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14695 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14696 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014697 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014698
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014699sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014700sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14701sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14702sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014703 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14704 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14705 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14706
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014707sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014708sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14709sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14710sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014711 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14712 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014713 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014714 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14715 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014716 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14717 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14718 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014720so_id : integer
14721 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14722 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14723 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014725src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014726 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014727 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14728 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14729 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014730 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14731 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14732 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014733 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
14734 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
14735 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
14736 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
14737 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
14738 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
14739 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014740
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014741 Example:
14742 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14743 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014745src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14746 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14747 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14748 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014749 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014751src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14752 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14753 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014754 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014755 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014757src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14758 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14759 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14760 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14761 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14762 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14763 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014764
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014765 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014766 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14767 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14768 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14769 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014770 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014771 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14772 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14773
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014774src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14775 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14776 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14777 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14778 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14779 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14780 was verified.
14781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014782src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014783 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014784 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014785 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014786 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014788src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014789 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014790 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14791 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014792 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014794src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14795 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14796 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14797 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014798 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014800src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014801 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014802 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014803 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014804 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014805
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014806src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14807 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14808 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14809 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14810 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14811
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014812src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14813 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14814 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14815 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14816 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014818src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014819 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014820 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014821 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14822 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014823 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14824 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14825 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014826
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014827src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14828 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14829 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14830 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14831 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14832 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14833 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14834 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014836src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014837 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014838 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014839 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014840 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014841 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014843src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14844 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14845 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14846 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14847 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014848 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014850src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014851 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014852 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14853 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014854 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014856src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14857 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14858 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14859 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014860 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014861 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014863src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14864 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14865 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14866 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014867 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014868 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14869 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014870
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014871 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014872 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014873 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014874 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014875
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014876src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14877 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14878 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14879 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
14880 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14881 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14882 connection when a first ACL was verified.
14883
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014884src_is_local : boolean
14885 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14886 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14887 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14888 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014889 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014890 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
14891 once per connection.
14892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014893src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014894 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
14895 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
14896 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
14897 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
14898 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014900src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014901 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
14902 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14903 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
14904 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
14905 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014907src_port : integer
14908 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
14909 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
14910 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
14911 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014913src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014914 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014915 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14916 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
14917 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014918 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014920src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14921 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
14922 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14923 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14924 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014925 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014927src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14928 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
14929 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
14930 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
14931 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
14932 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
14933 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
14934 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
14935 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014936
14937 Example :
14938 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
14939 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
14940 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
14941 listen ssh
14942 bind :22
14943 mode tcp
14944 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014945 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014946 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014947 server local 127.0.0.1:22
14948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014949srv_id : integer
14950 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
14951 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
14952 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020014953
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200149547.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014955----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020014956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014957The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
14958closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
14959when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
14960usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014961future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014962
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001496351d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
14964 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14965 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14966 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
14967 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14968 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14969
14970 Example :
14971 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
14972 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
14973 # the request.
14974 frontend http-in
14975 bind *:8081
14976 default_backend servers
14977 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14978 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14979
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014980ssl_bc : boolean
14981 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14982 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
14983 other a server with the "ssl" option.
14984
14985ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
14986 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
14987 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14988
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010014989ssl_bc_alpn : string
14990 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
14991 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020014992 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010014993 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
14994 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
14995 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
14996 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
14997 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
14998 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
14999
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015000ssl_bc_cipher : string
15001 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15002 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15003
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015004ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15005 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15006 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15007 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15008
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015009ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15010 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15011 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15012 session or a TLS ticket.
15013
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015014ssl_bc_npn : string
15015 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15016 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015017 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015018 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15019 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15020 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15021 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15022 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15023
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015024ssl_bc_protocol : string
15025 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15026 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15027
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015028ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015029 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015030 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15031 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015032
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015033ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15034 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15035 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15036 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15037
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015038ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15039 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15040 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15041 if session was reused or not.
15042
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015043ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15044 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15045 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15046 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15047 BoringSSL.
15048
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015049ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15050 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15051 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015053ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15054 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15055 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15056 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15057 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15058 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015060ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15061 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15062 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15063 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15064 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015065
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015066ssl_c_der : binary
15067 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15068 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15069 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015071ssl_c_err : integer
15072 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15073 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15074 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15075 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15076 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015078ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15079 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15080 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15081 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15082 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15083 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15084 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15085 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15086 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015088ssl_c_key_alg : string
15089 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15090 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15091 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015093ssl_c_notafter : string
15094 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15095 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15096 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015098ssl_c_notbefore : string
15099 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15100 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15101 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015103ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15104 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15105 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15106 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15107 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15108 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15109 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15110 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15111 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015113ssl_c_serial : binary
15114 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15115 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15116 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015118ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15119 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15120 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15121 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015122 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15123 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15124
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015125 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015126 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015128ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15129 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15130 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15131 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015133ssl_c_used : boolean
15134 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15135 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015137ssl_c_verify : integer
15138 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15139 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15140 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15141 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015143ssl_c_version : integer
15144 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15145 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015146
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015147ssl_f_der : binary
15148 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15149 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15150 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015152ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15153 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15154 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15155 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15156 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015157 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015158 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15159 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15160 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015162ssl_f_key_alg : string
15163 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15164 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15165 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015167ssl_f_notafter : string
15168 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15169 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15170 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015172ssl_f_notbefore : string
15173 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15174 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15175 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015177ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15178 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15179 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15180 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15181 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15182 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15183 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15184 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15185 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015187ssl_f_serial : binary
15188 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15189 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15190 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015191
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015192ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15193 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15194 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15195 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015197ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15198 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15199 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15200 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015202ssl_f_version : integer
15203 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15204 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15205
15206ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015207 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15208 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15209 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015211 Example :
15212 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15213 listen http-https
15214 bind :80
15215 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15216 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15217
15218ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15219 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15220 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15221
15222ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015223 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015224 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15225 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15226 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15227 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15228 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15229 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15230 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15231 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015233ssl_fc_cipher : string
15234 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15235 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015236
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015237ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15238 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15239 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015240 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015241
15242ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15243 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15244 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015245 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015246
15247ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15248 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15249 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15250 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015251 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015252 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015253
15254ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15255 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15256 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015257 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015258
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015259ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15260 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15261 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15262 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015264ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015265 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15266 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015267 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15268 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15269 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15270 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015271
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015272ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15273 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15274 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15275 wait until the handshake happened.
15276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015277ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15278 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015279 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15280 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015281 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015282 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015283
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015284ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015285 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015286 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15287 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015289ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015290 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015291 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15292 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15293 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15294 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15295 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15296 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15297 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015299ssl_fc_protocol : string
15300 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15301 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015302
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015303ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015304 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015305 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15306 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015307
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015308ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15309 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15310 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15311 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015313ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15314 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15315 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15316 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15317 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015318
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015319ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15320 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15321 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15322 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15323 BoringSSL.
15324
15325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015326ssl_fc_sni : string
15327 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15328 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15329 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15330 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15331 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15332
15333 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15334 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15335 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015336 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015337 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015339 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015340 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15341 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015343ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15344 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15345 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015346
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015347
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200153487.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015349------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015351Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15352sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15353only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15354For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15355be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15356can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15357sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15358for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15359content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015361payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015362 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015363 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15364 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015366payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15367 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015368 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015369 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015370
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015371req.hdrs : string
15372 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15373 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15374 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15375 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15376
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015377req.hdrs_bin : binary
15378 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15379 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15380 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15381 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15382 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15383 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15384
15385 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15386
15387 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15388 str: <int:length><bytes>
15389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015390req.len : integer
15391req_len : integer (deprecated)
15392 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15393 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15394 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15395 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15396 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15397 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15398 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15399 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015401req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15402 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015403 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15404 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15405 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15406 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015408 ACL alternatives :
15409 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015411req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15412 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15413 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15414 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15415 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015417 ACL alternatives :
15418 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015420 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015422req.proto_http : boolean
15423req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15424 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15425 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15426 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15427 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15428 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15429 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15430 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015432 Example:
15433 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15434 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15435 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015436 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015438req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15439rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15440 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15441 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15442 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15443 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15444 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15445 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15446 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015448 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15449 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15450 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15451 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15452 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15453 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015455 ACL derivatives :
15456 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015458 Example :
15459 listen tse-farm
15460 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15461 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15462 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15463 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15464 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15465 persist rdp-cookie
15466 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15467 # This is only useful makes sense if
15468 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15469 stick-table type string size 204800
15470 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15471 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15472 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015474 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15475 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015477req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15478rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15479 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15480 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15481 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15482 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015484 ACL derivatives :
15485 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015486
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015487req.ssl_alpn : string
15488 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15489 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15490 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15491 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15492 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15493 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015494 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015495
15496 Examples :
15497 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15498 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15499 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015500 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015501 default_backend bk_default
15502
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015503req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15504 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15505 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015506 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15507 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15508 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15509 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15510 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015512req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15513req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15514 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15515 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15516 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15517 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15518 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15519 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15520 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015522req.ssl_sni : string
15523req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15524 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15525 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15526 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15527 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15528 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15529 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15530 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15531 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15532 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15533 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15534 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15535 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015537 ACL derivatives :
15538 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015540 Examples :
15541 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15542 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15543 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15544 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15545 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015546
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015547req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15548 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15549 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15550 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15551 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15552 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15553 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15554 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15555 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15556 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015558req.ssl_ver : integer
15559req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15560 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15561 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15562 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15563 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15564 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15565 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15566 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015567 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015568 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015570 ACL derivatives :
15571 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015572
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015573res.len : integer
15574 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15575 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15576 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15577 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15578 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15579 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15580 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15581 content inspection.
15582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015583res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15584 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015585 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15586 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15587 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15588 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015590res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15591 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15592 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15593 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15594 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015596 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015597
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015598res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15599rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15600 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15601 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15602 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15603 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15604 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15605 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15606 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015608wait_end : boolean
15609 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15610 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015611 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015612 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15613 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015614 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015615 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15616 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015618 Examples :
15619 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15620 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15621 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015623 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15624 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15625 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15626 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15627 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15628 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15629 tcp-request content reject
15630
15631
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200156327.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015633--------------------------------------
15634
15635It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15636This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15637data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15638its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15639HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15640content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15641to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15642more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15643response are indexed.
15644
15645base : string
15646 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15647 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15648 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15649 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15650 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15651 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15652 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15653 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15654
15655 ACL derivatives :
15656 base : exact string match
15657 base_beg : prefix match
15658 base_dir : subdir match
15659 base_dom : domain match
15660 base_end : suffix match
15661 base_len : length match
15662 base_reg : regex match
15663 base_sub : substring match
15664
15665base32 : integer
15666 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15667 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15668 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015669 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15670 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15671 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015672
15673base32+src : binary
15674 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15675 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15676 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15677 per-URL counters.
15678
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015679capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15680 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15681 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15682 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15683
15684capture.req.method : string
15685 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15686 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15687 because it's allocated.
15688
15689capture.req.uri : string
15690 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15691 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15692 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15693 allocated.
15694
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015695capture.req.ver : string
15696 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15697 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15698 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15699
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015700capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15701 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15702 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15703 The first entry is an index of 0.
15704 See also: "capture response header"
15705
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015706capture.res.ver : string
15707 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15708 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15709 persistent flag.
15710
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015711req.body : binary
15712 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15713 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15714 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15715 the first chunk is analyzed.
15716
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015717req.body_param([<name>) : string
15718 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15719 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15720 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15721 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15722 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15723 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15724 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15725 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15726 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15727 given.
15728
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015729req.body_len : integer
15730 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15731 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15732 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15733 "option http-buffer-request".
15734
15735req.body_size : integer
15736 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15737 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15738 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15739 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15740 "option http-buffer-request".
15741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015742req.cook([<name>]) : string
15743cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15744 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15745 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15746 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15747 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15748 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15749 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15750 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15751 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15752
15753 ACL derivatives :
15754 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15755 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15756 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15757 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15758 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15759 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15760 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15761 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015763req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15764cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15765 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15766 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015768req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15769cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15770 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15771 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15772 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15773 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015775cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15776 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15777 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15778 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15779 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015780 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015781 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15782 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15783 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15784 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015786hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15787 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15788 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15789 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15790 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015791 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015793req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15794 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15795 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15796 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15797 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15798 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15799 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15800 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15801 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015803req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15804 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15805 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15806 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15807 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015809req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15810 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15811 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15812 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15813 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15814 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15815 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15816 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15817 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015818 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015819 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015820 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015822 ACL derivatives :
15823 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15824 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15825 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15826 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15827 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15828 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15829 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15830 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15831
15832req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15833hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15834 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15835 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15836 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15837 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15838 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15839 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15840 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15841 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15842 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15843
15844req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15845hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15846 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15847 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15848 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15849 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15850 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015851 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015852 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15853 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15854
15855req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15856hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15857 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15858 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15859 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15860 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15861 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15862 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15863 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15864
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010015865
15866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015867http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15868 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15869 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15870 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15871 basic auth is supported.
15872
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015873http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15874 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15875 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15876 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
15877 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015878 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15879 basic auth is supported.
15880
15881 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015882 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
15883 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
15884 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
15885 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015886
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020015887http_auth_pass : string
15888 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
15889 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
15890 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
15891
15892http_auth_type : string
15893 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
15894 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
15895 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
15896
15897http_auth_user : string
15898 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
15899 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
15900 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
15901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015902http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015903 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
15904 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015905 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
15906 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015908method : integer + string
15909 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
15910 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
15911 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
15912 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
15913 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
15914 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
15915 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015917 ACL derivatives :
15918 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015920 Example :
15921 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
15922 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
15923 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015925path : string
15926 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
15927 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
15928 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
15929 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
15930 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015931 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015932 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015934 ACL derivatives :
15935 path : exact string match
15936 path_beg : prefix match
15937 path_dir : subdir match
15938 path_dom : domain match
15939 path_end : suffix match
15940 path_len : length match
15941 path_reg : regex match
15942 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015943
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015944query : string
15945 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
15946 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
15947 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
15948 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015949 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015950 which stops before the question mark.
15951
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015952req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15953 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15954 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15955 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15956 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015958req.ver : string
15959req_ver : string (deprecated)
15960 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
15961 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
15962 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015964 ACL derivatives :
15965 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015967res.comp : boolean
15968 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
15969 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
15970 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015972res.comp_algo : string
15973 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
15974 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
15975 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015977res.cook([<name>]) : string
15978scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15979 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15980 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15981 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015983 ACL derivatives :
15984 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015986res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15987scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15988 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15989 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
15990 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015992res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15993scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15994 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15995 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
15996 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015998res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15999 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16000 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16001 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16002 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16003 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16004 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16005 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16006 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16007 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016009res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16010 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16011 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16012 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16013 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16014 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016016res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16017shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16018 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16019 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16020 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16021 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16022 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16023 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16024 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16025 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016027 ACL derivatives :
16028 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16029 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16030 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16031 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16032 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16033 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16034 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16035 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16036
16037res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16038shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16039 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16040 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16041 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16042 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16043 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016045res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16046shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16047 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16048 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16049 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16050 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16051 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16052 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016053
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016054res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16055 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16056 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16057 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16058 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016060res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16061shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16062 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16063 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16064 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16065 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16066 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16067 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016069res.ver : string
16070resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16071 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16072 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016074 ACL derivatives :
16075 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016077set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16078 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16079 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016080 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016081 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016083 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16084 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016086status : integer
16087 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16088 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16089 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016090
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016091unique-id : string
16092 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16093 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16094 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16095 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16096 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16097 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016099url : string
16100 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16101 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16102 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16103 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16104 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16105 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16106 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016108 ACL derivatives :
16109 url : exact string match
16110 url_beg : prefix match
16111 url_dir : subdir match
16112 url_dom : domain match
16113 url_end : suffix match
16114 url_len : length match
16115 url_reg : regex match
16116 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016118url_ip : ip
16119 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16120 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16121 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16122 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16123 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16124 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16125 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016127url_port : integer
16128 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16129 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16130 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16131 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016132
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016133urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16134url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016135 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16136 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016137 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16138 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16139 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16140 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016141 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16142 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016143 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16144 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016146 ACL derivatives :
16147 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16148 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16149 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16150 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16151 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16152 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16153 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16154 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016155
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016157 Example :
16158 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16159 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16160 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16161 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016162
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016163urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016164 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16165 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16166 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016167
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016168url32 : integer
16169 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16170 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16171 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16172 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16173 is an unsigned integer.
16174
16175url32+src : binary
16176 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16177 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16178 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16179
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200161817.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016182---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016183
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016184Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16185every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016186order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016187
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016188ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16189---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016190FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016191HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016192HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16193HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016194HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16195HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16196HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16197HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16198LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016199METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016200METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016201METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16202METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16203METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16204METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016205METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016206METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016207RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016208REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016209TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016210WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16211---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016212
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162148. Logging
16215----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016216
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016217One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16218provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16219very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16220provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16221state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016222to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016223headers.
16224
16225In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16226about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16227send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16228
16229 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16230 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16231 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16232 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16233 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016234 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016235 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016236
16237The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16238allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16239as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16240while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16241real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16242delay.
16243
16244
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162458.1. Log levels
16246---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016247
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016248TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016249source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016250HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16251in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16252track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16253syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16254about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016255
16256
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162578.2. Log formats
16258----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016259
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016260HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016261and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16262slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16263options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016264
16265 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16266 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16267 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16268 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16269 extents.
16270
16271 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16272 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16273 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16274 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16275 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16276
16277 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16278 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16279 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16280 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16281 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16282
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016283 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16284 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16285 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16286 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16287
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016288 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16289
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016290Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16291specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16292field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16293servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16294always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16295identifier.
16296
16297Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16298 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16299 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16300 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16301 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16302
16303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163048.2.1. Default log format
16305-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016306
16307This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16308as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16309format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16310
16311 Example :
16312 listen www
16313 mode http
16314 log global
16315 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16316
16317 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16318 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16319 (www/HTTP)
16320
16321 Field Format Extract from the example above
16322 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16323 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16324 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16325 4 'to' to
16326 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16327 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16328
16329Detailed fields description :
16330 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16331 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16332 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16333 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16334 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16335 and processed the connection.
16336 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16337
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016338In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16339"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16340connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16341
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016342It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16343will eventually disappear.
16344
16345
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163468.2.2. TCP log format
16347---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016348
16349The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16350is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16351information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16352counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16353emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16354environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16355the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16356sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016357specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16358not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16359fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16360marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016361
16362 Example :
16363 frontend fnt
16364 mode tcp
16365 option tcplog
16366 log global
16367 default_backend bck
16368
16369 backend bck
16370 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16371
16372 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16373 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16374 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16375
16376 Field Format Extract from the example above
16377 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16378 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16379 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16380 4 frontend_name fnt
16381 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16382 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16383 7 bytes_read* 212
16384 8 termination_state --
16385 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16386 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16387
16388Detailed fields description :
16389 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016390 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16391 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16392 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016393 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016394 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016395 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016396
16397 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016398 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16399 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16400 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016401
16402 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16403 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16404 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016405 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16406 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16407 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16408 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016409
16410 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16411 and processed the connection.
16412
16413 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16414 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16415 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16416 applications.
16417
16418 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16419 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16420 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16421 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16422 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16423
16424 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16425 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16426 See "Timers" below for more details.
16427
16428 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16429 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16430 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16431 "Timers" below for more details.
16432
16433 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016434 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016435 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16436 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16437 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16438 details.
16439
16440 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16441 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16442 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16443 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16444 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16445
16446 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16447 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16448 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16449 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16450 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16451 for more details.
16452
16453 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016454 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016455 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16456 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16457 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016458 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016459
16460 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16461 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16462 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16463 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16464 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16465 caused by a denial of service attack.
16466
16467 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16468 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16469 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16470 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16471 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16472 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16473 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16474 denial of service attack.
16475
16476 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16477 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16478 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16479 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16480 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16481 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16482 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16483 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16484 be processed than on other servers.
16485
16486 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16487 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16488 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16489 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16490 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16491 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16492 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16493 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16494 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16495 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16496 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16497 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16498 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16499
16500 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16501 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16502 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16503 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16504 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16505 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016506 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016507 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16508
16509 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16510 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16511 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16512 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16513 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16514 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016515 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016516 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16517 occurs.
16518
16519
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165208.2.3. HTTP log format
16521----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016522
16523The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16524is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16525the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16526are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16527emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16528generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16529"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16530which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016531frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16532is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016533
16534Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16535slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16536with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16537
16538 Example :
16539 frontend http-in
16540 mode http
16541 option httplog
16542 log global
16543 default_backend bck
16544
16545 backend static
16546 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16547
16548 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16549 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16550 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016551 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016552
16553 Field Format Extract from the example above
16554 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16555 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016556 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016557 4 frontend_name http-in
16558 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016559 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016560 7 status_code 200
16561 8 bytes_read* 2750
16562 9 captured_request_cookie -
16563 10 captured_response_cookie -
16564 11 termination_state ----
16565 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16566 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16567 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16568 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16569 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016570
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016571Detailed fields description :
16572 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016573 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16574 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16575 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016576 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016577 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016578 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016579
16580 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016581 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16582 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16583 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016584
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016585 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16586 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016587
16588 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16589 and processed the connection.
16590
16591 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16592 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16593 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16594
16595 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16596 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16597 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16598 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16599 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16600 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16601
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016602 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16603 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16604 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016605 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016606 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16607 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016608 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16609 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016610
16611 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16612 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016613 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016614
16615 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16616 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016617 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16618 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016619
16620 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16621 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16622 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16623 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16624 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016625 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16626 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016627
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016628 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16629 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16630 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16631 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16632 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16633 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16634 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016635 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016636
16637 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16638 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16639 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16640
16641 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16642 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016643 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016644 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16645 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16646 overflowing.
16647
16648 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16649 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16650 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16651 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16652 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16653 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16654 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16655 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16656
16657 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16658 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16659 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16660 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16661 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16662 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16663 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16664 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16665
16666 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16667 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16668 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16669 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16670 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16671 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16672 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16673
16674 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016675 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016676 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16677 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16678 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016679 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016680 system.
16681
16682 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16683 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16684 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16685 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16686 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16687 caused by a denial of service attack.
16688
16689 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16690 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16691 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16692 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16693 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16694 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16695 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16696 denial of service attack.
16697
16698 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16699 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16700 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16701 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16702 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16703 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16704 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16705 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16706 processed than on other servers.
16707
16708 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16709 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16710 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16711 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16712 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16713 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16714 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16715 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16716 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16717 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16718 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16719 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16720 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16721
16722 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16723 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16724 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16725 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16726 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16727 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016728 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016729 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16730
16731 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16732 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16733 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16734 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16735 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16736 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016737 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016738 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16739 occurs.
16740
16741 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16742 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16743 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16744 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16745 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16746 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16747 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16748 cookies" below for more details.
16749
16750 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16751 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16752 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16753 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16754 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16755 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16756 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16757 and cookies" below for more details.
16758
16759 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16760 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16761 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16762 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16763 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16764 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16765 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16766 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16767
16768
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200167698.2.4. Custom log format
16770------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016771
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016772The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016773mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016774
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016775HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016776Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16777separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16778prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16779
16780Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16781variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016782("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016783
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016784If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016785as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016786less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16787the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16788
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016789Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016790In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016791in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016792
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016793Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16794'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16795https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16796such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16797
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016798Flags are :
16799 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016800 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016801 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16802 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016803
16804 Example:
16805
16806 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16807 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16808
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016809 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16810
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016811At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16812
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016813 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16814 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016815
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016816the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016817
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016818 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16819 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16820 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016821
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016822and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16823
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016824 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16825 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016826
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016827Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16828
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016829 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016830 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016831 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16832 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16833 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016834 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16835 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16836 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016837 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016838 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16839 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016840 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016841 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16842 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016843 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016844 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016845 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016846 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016847 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016848 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016849 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016850 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16851 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16852 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16853 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16854 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016855 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016856 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16857 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016858 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016859 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16860 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016861 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16862 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16863 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016864 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016865 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16866 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016867 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016868 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16869 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16870 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016871 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016872 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016873 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16874 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16875 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16876 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016877 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016878 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016879 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016880 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016881 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016882 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016883 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
16884 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
16885 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016886 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016887 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16888 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016889 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016890 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
16891 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020016892 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016893 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016894 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016895 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016896
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016897 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016898
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016899
169008.2.5. Error log format
16901-----------------------
16902
16903When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
16904protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
16905By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
16906"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016907will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016908logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
16909
16910The format looks like this :
16911
16912 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
16913 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
16914 Connection error during SSL handshake
16915
16916 Field Format Extract from the example above
16917 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
16918 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
16919 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
16920 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
16921 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
16922
16923These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
16924failures.
16925
16926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169278.3. Advanced logging options
16928-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016929
16930Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
16931just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
16932options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
16933for more information about their usage.
16934
16935
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169368.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
16937------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016938
16939It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
16940haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
16941commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
16942monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
16943ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
16944
16945 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
16946 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
16947 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
16948 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
16949
16950 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
16951 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
16952 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016953 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016954 such as other load-balancers.
16955
16956 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
16957 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
16958 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
16959
16960
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169618.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
16962----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016963
16964The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
16965what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
16966or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016967"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016968just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
16969log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
16970after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
16971is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
16972with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
16973with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
16974
16975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169768.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
16977------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016978
16979Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
16980for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
16981"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
16982retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
16983raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
16984a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
16985file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
16986you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
16987"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
16988
16989
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169908.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
16991--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016992
16993Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
16994multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
16995them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
16996"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
16997logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
16998error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
16999and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17000too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17001useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17002alternative.
17003
17004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170058.4. Timing events
17006------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017007
17008Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17009reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17010the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17011frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017012mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17013addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17014
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017015Timings events in HTTP mode:
17016
17017 first request 2nd request
17018 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17019 t tr t tr ...
17020 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17021 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17022 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17023 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17024 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17025
17026Timings events in TCP mode:
17027
17028 TCP session
17029 |<----------------->|
17030 t t
17031 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17032 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17033 |<------ Tt ------->|
17034
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017035 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017036 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017037 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17038 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17039 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017040 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017041 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17042 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17043 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17044 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017045
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017046 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17047 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17048 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017049 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17050 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17051 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17052 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17053 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17054 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017055
17056 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17057 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17058 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17059 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17060 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17061 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17062 request typed by hand during a test.
17063
17064 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17065 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017066 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017067 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17068 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17069 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17070 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017071
17072 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17073 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17074 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17075 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17076 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17077
17078 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17079 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17080 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17081 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17082 connection never established.
17083
17084 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17085 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17086 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17087 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17088 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17089 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17090 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17091 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17092 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17093 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17094 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17095
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017096 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17097 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17098 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17099 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17100 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17101 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17102
17103 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17104
17105 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17106 "Ta" can never be negative.
17107
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017108 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17109 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017110 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17111 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017112 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017113
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017114 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017115
17116 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017117 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17118 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017119
17120These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17121protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17122that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017123due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17124"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17125that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017126
17127Most common cases :
17128
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017129 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17130 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17131 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17132 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17133 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17134 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17135 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17136 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17137 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17138 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17139 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017140 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017141
17142 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17143 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17144 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17145 of ms on remote networks.
17146
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017147 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17148 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17149 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017150
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017151 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17152 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17153 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17154 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17155 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17156 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17157 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17158 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17159 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017160
17161Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17162
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017163 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017164 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017165 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017166
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017167 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017168 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17169 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17170
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017171 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017172 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17173 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17174 flags.
17175
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017176 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17177 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017178 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17179 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17180 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17181 the client connection was maintained open.
17182
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017183 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017184 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017185 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017186 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17187
17188
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171898.5. Session state at disconnection
17190-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017191
17192TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17193"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
171942-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17195each of which has a special meaning :
17196
17197 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17198 session to terminate :
17199
17200 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17201
17202 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17203 server explicitly refused it.
17204
17205 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17206 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17207 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17208 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017209 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017210
17211 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17212 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017213
17214 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17215 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17216 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17217 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17218 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17219
17220 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17221 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17222 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17223 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17224 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17225
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017226 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17227 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17228
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017229 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17230 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17231 backup connections when going up.
17232
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017233 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17234
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017235 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17236 send or receive data.
17237
17238 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17239 send or receive data.
17240
17241 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17242 with nothing left in the buffers.
17243
17244 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17245
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017246 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017247 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17248
17249 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17250 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17251 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17252 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17253 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17254
17255 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17256 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17257
17258 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17259 server (HTTP only).
17260
17261 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17262
17263 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17264 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17265 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17266
17267 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17268 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17269 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17270
17271 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17272
17273 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17274 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17275
17276 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17277 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17278 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17279
17280 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17281 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017282 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17283 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017284
17285 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17286 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17287 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17288 another server.
17289
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017290 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017291 server.
17292
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017293 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17294 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17295 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17296 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17297
17298 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17299 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17300 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17301 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17302
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017303 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17304 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17305 "use-server" rule).
17306
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017307 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17308
17309 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17310 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17311
17312 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17313
17314 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17315 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17316 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17317
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017318 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17319 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017320 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017321 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17322 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17323
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017324 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17325
17326 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17327 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17328
17329 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17330
17331 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17332
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017333The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17334was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017335helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17336starvation, attacks, etc...
17337
17338The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17339alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17340easier finding and understanding.
17341
17342 Flags Reason
17343
17344 -- Normal termination.
17345
17346 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17347 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17348 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17349 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17350
17351 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17352 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17353 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17354 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17355 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17356 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017357
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017358 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17359 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017360 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017361
17362 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17363 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17364 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17365
17366 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17367 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17368 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17369 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17370 the server takes too long to respond.
17371
17372 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17373 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17374 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17375 long a time to respond.
17376
17377 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17378 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17379 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17380 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017381 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17382 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017383
17384 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17385 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17386 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17387 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17388 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017389 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017390 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17391 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17392 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17393 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17394 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17395 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17396 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17397 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017398 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017399 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17400 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17401 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017402
17403 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17404 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017405 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17406 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17407 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17408 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017409
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017410 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17411 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17412
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017413 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017414 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17415 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017416 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017417 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17418 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17419
17420 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17421 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17422 503 or 504 here.
17423
17424 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17425 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17426 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17427 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17428 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17429
17430 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17431 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017432 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017433 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17434 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17435
17436 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17437 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17438 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17439 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17440 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17441 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17442 between haproxy and the server.
17443
17444 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17445 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17446 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17447 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17448 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17449 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17450 solution is to fix the application.
17451
17452 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17453 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17454 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17455 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17456 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17457 external attacks.
17458
17459 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17460 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017461 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017462 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17463 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17464
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017465 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17466 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17467 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017468 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017469 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017470
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017471 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17472 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17473 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17474 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017475 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17476 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17477 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17478 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17479 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017480
17481 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17482 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17483 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17484 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17485
17486 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17487 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17488 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17489 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17490
17491 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17492 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17493 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17494 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17495
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017496The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17497persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17498important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17499re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17500
17501 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17502
17503 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17504 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17505 set on a GET request.
17506
17507 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17508 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017509 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017510 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17511
17512 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17513 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17514 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17515
17516 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17517 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17518 already got a cookie.
17519
17520 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17521 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17522 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17523 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17524 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17525
17526 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17527 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17528 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17529
17530 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17531 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17532 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17533
17534 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17535 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17536
17537 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17538 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17539 then advertised in the response.
17540
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017541
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175428.6. Non-printable characters
17543-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017544
17545In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17546consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17547converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17548prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17549being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17550escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17551is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17552'}' when logging headers.
17553
17554Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17555issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17556containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17557
17558Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17559the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17560performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17561
17562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175638.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17564---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017565
17566Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17567achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017568section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017569cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17570the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17571the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017572locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017573not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17574user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17575a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17576wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17577
17578 Examples :
17579 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17580 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17581
17582 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17583 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17584
17585
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175868.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17587---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017588
17589Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17590proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17591the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17592server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17593
17594Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17595response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017596section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017597
17598It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017599time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17600appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017601are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17602and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17603follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17604request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17605in the logs.
17606
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017607As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17608frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17609an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17610
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017611 Example :
17612 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17613 listen proxy-out
17614 mode http
17615 option httplog
17616 option logasap
17617 log global
17618 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17619
17620 # log the name of the virtual server
17621 capture request header Host len 20
17622
17623 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17624 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17625
17626 # log the beginning of the referrer
17627 capture request header Referer len 20
17628
17629 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17630 capture response header Server len 20
17631
17632 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17633 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17634
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017635 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017636 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17637
17638 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17639 capture response header Via len 20
17640
17641 # log the URL location during a redirection
17642 capture response header Location len 20
17643
17644 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17645 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17646 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17647 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17648 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17649
17650 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17651 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17652 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17653 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017654 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017655
17656 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17657 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17658 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17659 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17660 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017661 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017662
17663
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176648.9. Examples of logs
17665---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017666
17667These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17668them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17669reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17670
17671 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17672 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17673 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17674
17675 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17676 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17677
17678 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17679 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17680 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17681
17682 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17683 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17684
17685 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17686 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17687 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17688
17689 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017690 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017691 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17692 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17693
17694 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17695 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17696 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17697
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017698 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
17699 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
17700 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
17701 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
17702 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
17703 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017704
17705 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017706 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017707
17708 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17709 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17710 Nothing was sent to any server.
17711
17712 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17713 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17714
17715 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17716 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017717 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017718 send a 408 return code to the client.
17719
17720 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17721 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17722
17723 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17724 5 seconds ("c----").
17725
17726 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17727 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017728 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017729
17730 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017731 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017732 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17733 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17734 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17735 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17736 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017737
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017738
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200177399. Supported filters
17740--------------------
17741
17742Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17743accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17744unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17745
17746See also : "filter"
17747
177489.1. Trace
17749----------
17750
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017751filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017752
17753 Arguments:
17754 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17755 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17756
17757 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17758 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17759 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17760 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17761
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017762 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017763 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17764 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17765 amount of the parsed data.
17766
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017767 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017768
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017769This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17770callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17771information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17772filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17773
17774Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17775tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17776a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17777
17778
177799.2. HTTP compression
17780---------------------
17781
17782filter compression
17783
17784The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17785keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017786when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
17787fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
17788done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
17789explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
17790filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
17791listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17792order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017793
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017794See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
17795 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017796
17797
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200177989.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17799--------------------------------------------
17800
17801filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17802
17803 Arguments :
17804
17805 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17806 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17807 parsed.
17808
17809 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17810 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17811 part must be placed in its own scope.
17812
17813The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17814external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017815streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017816exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17817also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17818
17819SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17820the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17821
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017822For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017823"doc/SPOE.txt".
17824
17825Important note:
17826 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17827 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17828
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100178299.4. Cache
17830----------
17831
17832filter cache <name>
17833
17834 Arguments :
17835
17836 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
17837
17838The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
17839"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017840cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017841other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
17842case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
17843is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
17844filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017845listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17846order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017847
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017848See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
17849 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
17850
17851
178529.5. Fcgi-app
17853-------------
17854
17855filter fcg-app <name>
17856
17857 Arguments :
17858
17859 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
17860
17861The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
17862request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
17863reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
17864used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
17865implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
17866used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
17867fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
17868used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17869order.
17870
17871See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
17872 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
17873
17874
1787510. FastCGI applications
17876-------------------------
17877
17878HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
17879feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
17880the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
17881FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
17882servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
17883FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
17884backend.
17885
17886HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
17887application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
17888connection.
17889
1789010.1. Setup
17891-----------
17892
1789310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
17894--------------------------
17895
17896fcgi-app <name>
17897 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
17898 document root must be defined.
17899
17900acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
17901 Declare or complete an access list.
17902
17903 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
17904 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
17905 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
17906 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
17907 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
17908
17909docroot <path>
17910 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
17911 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
17912 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
17913
17914index <script-name>
17915 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
17916 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
17917 is an optional setting.
17918
17919 Example :
17920 index index.php
17921
17922log-stderr global
17923log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
17924 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
17925 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
17926
17927 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
17928 default STDERR messages are ignored.
17929
17930pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
17931 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
17932 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
17933 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
17934
17935 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
17936 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
17937 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
17938 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
17939
17940 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
17941 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
17942
17943path-info <regex>
17944 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info
17945 from the URI. Thus, <regex> should have two captures: the first one to
17946 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. It is an
17947 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
17948 URI. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not filled.
17949
17950 Example :
17951 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
17952
17953option get-values
17954no option get-values
17955 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
17956
17957 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
17958 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
17959
17960 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
17961 application will accept.
17962
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020017963 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
17964 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017965
17966 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
17967 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
17968 option is disabled.
17969
17970 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
17971 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
17972 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
17973 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
17974 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
17975 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
17976
17977option keep-conn
17978no option keep-conn
17979 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
17980 sending a response.
17981
17982 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
17983 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
17984
17985option max-reqs <reqs>
17986 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
17987 accept.
17988
17989 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
17990 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
17991 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
17992 to 1.
17993
17994option mpxs-conns
17995no option mpxs-conns
17996 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
17997
17998 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
17999 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
18000
18001set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18002 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
18003 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
18004 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
18005 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18006
18007 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
18008 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
18009 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
18010
18011 Example :
18012 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
18013 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
18014
18015 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
18016
18017
1801810.1.2. Proxy section
18019---------------------
18020
18021use-fcgi-app <name>
18022 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
18023
18024 Arguments :
18025 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
18026
18027 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
18028 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
18029 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
18030 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
18031 application may be defined at a time per backend.
18032
18033 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
18034 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
18035 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
18036 application are evaluated.
18037
18038
1803910.1.3. Example
18040---------------
18041
18042 frontend front-http
18043 mode http
18044 bind *:80
18045 bind *:
18046
18047 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
18048 default_backend back-static
18049
18050 backend back-static
18051 mode http
18052 server www A.B.C.D:80
18053
18054 backend back-dynamic
18055 mode http
18056 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
18057 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
18058
18059 fcgi-app php-fpm
18060 log-stderr global
18061 option keep-conn
18062
18063 docroot /var/www/my-app
18064 index index.php
18065 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18066
18067
1806810.2. Default parameters
18069------------------------
18070
18071A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
18072the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
18073scipt. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
18074applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
18075
18076 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18077 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
18078 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
18079 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
18080 | | |
18081 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18082 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
18083 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
18084 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
18085 | | application. |
18086 | | |
18087 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18088 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
18089 | | the request. It may not be set. |
18090 | | |
18091 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18092 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
18093 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
18094 | | the application's configuration. |
18095 | | |
18096 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18097 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
18098 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
18099 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
18100 | | |
18101 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18102 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
18103 | | following the part that identifies the script |
18104 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
18105 | | be defined. |
18106 | | |
18107 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18108 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
18109 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
18110 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
18111 | | is not set too. |
18112 | | |
18113 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18114 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
18115 | | set. |
18116 | | |
18117 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18118 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
18119 | | the request. |
18120 | | |
18121 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18122 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
18123 | | client as part of user authentication. |
18124 | | |
18125 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18126 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
18127 | | script to process the request. |
18128 | | |
18129 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18130 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
18131 | | |
18132 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18133 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
18134 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
18135 | | |
18136 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18137 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
18138 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
18139 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
18140 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
18141 | | |
18142 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18143 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
18144 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
18145 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
18146 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
18147 | | side. |
18148 | | |
18149 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18150 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
18151 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
18152 | | connected to. |
18153 | | |
18154 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18155 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
18156 | | |
18157 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18158 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
18159 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
18160 | | |
18161 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18162
18163
1816410.3. Limitations
18165------------------
18166
18167The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
18168way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
18169during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
18170establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
18171application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
18172or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
18173message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
18174these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
18175and HTTP servers under the same backend.
18176
18177Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
18178request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
18179requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
18180
18181About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
18182into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
18183fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
18184"http-request" ones.
18185
18186Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
18187FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
18188processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
18189must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
18190here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018191
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018192/*
18193 * Local variables:
18194 * fill-column: 79
18195 * End:
18196 */